Generalize run-time debugging checks.
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <signal.h>
25 #include <stdio.h>
26 #include <setjmp.h>
27
28 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
29
30 #include "lisp.h"
31 #include "blockinput.h"
32
33 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
34 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
35 #include "syssignal.h"
36
37 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
38 if this is not done before the other system files. */
39 #include "xterm.h"
40 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
41
42 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
43 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
44 #ifndef makedev
45 #include <sys/types.h>
46 #endif /* makedev */
47
48 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
49
50 #include "systime.h"
51
52 #include <fcntl.h>
53 #include <ctype.h>
54 #include <errno.h>
55 #include <setjmp.h>
56 #include <sys/stat.h>
57 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
58 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
59
60 #include "charset.h"
61 #include "character.h"
62 #include "coding.h"
63 #include "frame.h"
64 #include "dispextern.h"
65 #include "fontset.h"
66 #include "termhooks.h"
67 #include "termopts.h"
68 #include "termchar.h"
69 #include "emacs-icon.h"
70 #include "disptab.h"
71 #include "buffer.h"
72 #include "window.h"
73 #include "keyboard.h"
74 #include "intervals.h"
75 #include "process.h"
76 #include "atimer.h"
77 #include "keymap.h"
78 #include "font.h"
79 #include "fontset.h"
80 #include "xsettings.h"
81 #include "xgselect.h"
82 #include "sysselect.h"
83
84 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
85 #include <X11/Shell.h>
86 #endif
87
88 #include <unistd.h>
89
90 #ifdef USE_GTK
91 #include "gtkutil.h"
92 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
93 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
94 #endif
95 #endif
96
97 #ifdef USE_LUCID
98 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
99 #endif
100
101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
102 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
103 #define HACK_EDITRES
104 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
105 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
106
107 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
108
109 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
110 #if defined USE_MOTIF
111 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
112 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
113 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
114
115 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
116 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
117 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
118 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
119 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
120 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
121 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
122 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
123 #ifndef XtNpickTop
124 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
125 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
126 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
127 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
128
129 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
130
131 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
132 #include "widget.h"
133 #ifndef XtNinitialState
134 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
135 #endif
136 #endif
137
138 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
139
140 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
141 #ifdef USE_XIM
142 int use_xim = 1;
143 #else
144 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
145 #endif
146
147 \f
148
149 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
150 start. */
151
152 static int any_help_event_p;
153
154 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
155 static Lisp_Object last_window;
156
157 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
158 use. */
159
160 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
161
162 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
163 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
164 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
165 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
166
167 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
168
169 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
170 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
171 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
172 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
173
174 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
175
176 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
177
178 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
179
180 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
181
182 static struct {
183 struct frame *f;
184 int eventtype;
185 } pending_event_wait;
186
187 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
188 /* The application context for Xt use. */
189 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
190 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
191
192 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
193
194 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
195 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
196
197 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
198 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
199 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
200
201 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
202
203 /* Mouse movement.
204
205 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
206 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
207 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
208 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
209
210 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
211
212 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
213 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
214 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
215 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
216 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
217 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
218 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
219 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
220 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
221 is off. */
222
223 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
224
225 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
226 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
228
229 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
230
231 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
232 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
233 an ordinary motion.
234
235 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
236 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
237 event. */
238
239 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
240
241 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
242 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
243 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
244 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
245 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
246 it's somewhat accurate. */
247
248 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
249
250 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
251
252 static Time last_user_time;
253
254 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
255 events. */
256
257 static int volatile input_signal_count;
258
259 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
260
261 static int x_noop_count;
262
263 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
264
265 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
266 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
267
268 #ifdef USE_GTK
269 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
270 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
271
272 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
273 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
274 #endif
275
276 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
277 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
278
279 enum xembed_info
280 {
281 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
282 };
283
284 enum xembed_message
285 {
286 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
287 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
288 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
289 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
290 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
291 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
292 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
293 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
294
295 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
296 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
297 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
298 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
299 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
300 };
301
302 /* Used in x_flush. */
303
304 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
305 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
306 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
307 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
308 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
309 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
310
311 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
312 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
313 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
314 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
315 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
316 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
317 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
318 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
319 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
320 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
321 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
322 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
323 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
324 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
325 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
326 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
327 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
328 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
329 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
330 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
331 enum text_cursor_kinds);
332
333 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
334 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
335 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
336 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
337 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
338 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
339 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
340 enum scroll_bar_part *,
341 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
342 Time *);
343 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
344 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
345 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
346 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
347 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
348 int *, struct input_event *);
349 #ifdef USE_GTK
350 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
351 #endif
352 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
353 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
354 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
355 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
356 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
357 static void x_initialize (void);
358
359
360 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
361
362 static void
363 x_flush (struct frame *f)
364 {
365 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
366 connection may be broken. */
367 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
368 return;
369
370 BLOCK_INPUT;
371 if (f == NULL)
372 {
373 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
374 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
375 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
377 }
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
381 }
382
383
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
390
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
392
393 \f
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
397
398 #if 0
399
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
402
403 struct record
404 {
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
407 };
408
409 struct record event_record[100];
410
411 int event_record_index;
412
413 void
414 record_event (char *locus, int type)
415 {
416 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
417 event_record_index = 0;
418
419 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
420 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
421 event_record_index++;
422 }
423
424 #endif /* 0 */
425
426
427 \f
428 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
429
430 struct x_display_info *
431 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
432 {
433 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
434
435 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
436 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
437 return dpyinfo;
438
439 return 0;
440 }
441
442 static Window
443 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
444 {
445 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
446 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
447 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
448
449 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
450 {
451 Window root;
452 Window *children;
453 unsigned int nchildren;
454
455 win = wi;
456 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
457 XFree (children);
458 }
459
460 return win;
461 }
462
463 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
464
465 void
466 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
467 {
468 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
469 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
470 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
471 double alpha = 1.0;
472 double alpha_min = 1.0;
473 unsigned long opac;
474 Window parent;
475
476 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
477 alpha = f->alpha[0];
478 else
479 alpha = f->alpha[1];
480
481 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
482 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
483 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
484 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
485
486 if (alpha < 0.0)
487 return;
488 else if (alpha > 1.0)
489 alpha = 1.0;
490 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
491 alpha = alpha_min;
492
493 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
494
495 x_catch_errors (dpy);
496
497 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
498 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
499 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
500 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
501
502 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
503 if (parent != None)
504 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
506 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
507
508 /* return unless necessary */
509 {
510 unsigned char *data;
511 Atom actual;
512 int rc, format;
513 unsigned long n, left;
514
515 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
516 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
517 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
518 &data);
519
520 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
521 {
522 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
523 XFree ((void *) data);
524 if (value == opac)
525 {
526 x_uncatch_errors ();
527 return;
528 }
529 }
530 }
531
532 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
533 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
534 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
535 x_uncatch_errors ();
536 }
537
538 int
539 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
540 {
541 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
542 }
543
544 int
545 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
546 {
547 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
548 }
549
550 \f
551 /***********************************************************************
552 Starting and ending an update
553 ***********************************************************************/
554
555 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
556 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
557 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
558 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
559 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
560
561 static void
562 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
563 {
564 /* Nothing to do. */
565 }
566
567
568 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
569 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
570 position of W. */
571
572 static void
573 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
574 {
575 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
576 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
577
578 updated_window = w;
579 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
580
581 BLOCK_INPUT;
582
583 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
584 {
585 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
586 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
587
588 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
589 highlighting. */
590 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
591 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
592 }
593
594 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
595 }
596
597
598 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
599
600 static void
601 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
602 {
603 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
604 struct face *face;
605
606 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
607 if (face)
608 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
609 face->foreground);
610
611 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
612 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
613 }
614
615 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
616
617 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
618 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
619
620 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
621 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
622 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
623
624 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
625 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
626 here. */
627
628 static void
629 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
630 {
631 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
632
633 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
634 {
635 BLOCK_INPUT;
636
637 if (cursor_on_p)
638 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
639 output_cursor.vpos,
640 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
641
642 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
643 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
644
645 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
646 }
647
648 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
649 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
650 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
651 {
652 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
653 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
654 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
655 }
656
657 updated_window = NULL;
658 }
659
660
661 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
662 update_end. */
663
664 static void
665 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
666 {
667 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
668 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
669
670 #ifndef XFlush
671 BLOCK_INPUT;
672 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
673 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
674 #endif
675 }
676
677
678 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
679 complete update has been performed. The global variable
680 updated_window is not available here. */
681
682 static void
683 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
684 {
685 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
686 {
687 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
688
689 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
690 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
691 {
692 BLOCK_INPUT;
693 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
694 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
695 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
696 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
697 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
698 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
699 }
700 }
701 }
702
703
704 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
705 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
706 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
707 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
708 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
709 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
710
711 static void
712 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
713 {
714 struct window *w = updated_window;
715 struct frame *f;
716 int width, height;
717
718 eassert (w);
719
720 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
721 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
722
723 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
724 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
725 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
726 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
727 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
728 overhead is very small. */
729 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
730 && desired_row->full_width_p
731 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
732 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
733 width != 0)
734 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
735 height > 0))
736 {
737 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
738
739 BLOCK_INPUT;
740 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
741 0, y, width, height, False);
742 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
743 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
744 y, width, height, False);
745 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
746 }
747 }
748
749 static void
750 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
751 {
752 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
753 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
754 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
755 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
756 struct face *face = p->face;
757
758 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
759 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
760
761 if (!p->overlay_p)
762 {
763 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
764
765 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
766 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
767 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
768 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
769 if (face->stipple)
770 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
771 else
772 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
773
774 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
775 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
776 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
777 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
778 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
779 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
780 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
781 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
782 {
783 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
784
785 if (sb_width > 0)
786 {
787 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
788 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
789 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
790
791 if (bx < 0)
792 {
793 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
794 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
795 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
796 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
797 bx = bar_area_x;
798 if (bx >= 0)
799 {
800 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
801
802 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
803 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
804 row->y));
805 ny = row->visible_height;
806 }
807 }
808 else
809 {
810 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
811 {
812 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
813 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
814 }
815 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
816 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
817 }
818 }
819 }
820 #endif
821 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
822 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
823
824 if (!face->stipple)
825 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
826 }
827
828 if (p->which)
829 {
830 char *bits;
831 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
832 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
833 XGCValues gcv;
834
835 if (p->wd > 8)
836 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
837 else
838 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
839
840 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
841 by the server. */
842 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
843 (p->cursor_p
844 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
845 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
846 : face->foreground),
847 face->background, depth);
848
849 if (p->overlay_p)
850 {
851 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
852 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
853 bits, p->wd, p->h,
854 1, 0, 1);
855 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
856 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
857 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
858 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
859 }
860
861 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
862 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
863 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
864
865 if (p->overlay_p)
866 {
867 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
868 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
869 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
870 }
871 }
872
873 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
874 }
875
876 \f
877
878 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
879 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
880 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
881 rarely happens). */
882
883 static void
884 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
885 {
886 }
887
888 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
889 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
890
891 static void
892 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
893 {
894 }
895
896 \f
897 /***********************************************************************
898 Glyph display
899 ***********************************************************************/
900
901
902
903 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
904 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
905 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
906 int);
907 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
908 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
911 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
912 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
913 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
914 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
915 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
916 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
917 unsigned long *, double, int);
918 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
919 double, int, unsigned long);
920 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
921 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
922 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
923 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
924 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
925 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
926 int, int, int);
927 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
928 int, int, int, int, int, int,
929 XRectangle *);
930 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
931 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
932 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
933
934 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
935 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
936 #endif
937
938
939 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
940 face. */
941
942 static void
943 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
944 {
945 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
946 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
947 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
948 && !s->cmp)
949 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
950 else
951 {
952 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
953 XGCValues xgcv;
954 unsigned long mask;
955
956 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
957 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
958
959 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
960 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
961 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
962 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
963 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
964 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
965 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
966
967 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
968 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
969 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
970 {
971 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
972 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
973 }
974
975 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
976 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
977 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
978
979 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
980 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
981 mask, &xgcv);
982 else
983 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
984 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
985
986 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
987 }
988 }
989
990
991 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
992
993 static void
994 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
995 {
996 int face_id;
997 struct face *face;
998
999 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1000 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1001 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1002 if (face == NULL)
1003 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1004
1005 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1006 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1007 else
1008 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1009 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1010 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1011
1012 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1013 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1014 else
1015 {
1016 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1017 except for FONT. */
1018 XGCValues xgcv;
1019 unsigned long mask;
1020
1021 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1022 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1023 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1024 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1025
1026 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1027 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1028 mask, &xgcv);
1029 else
1030 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1031 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1032
1033 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1034
1035 }
1036 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1037 }
1038
1039
1040 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1041 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1042 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1043
1044 static inline void
1045 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1046 {
1047 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1048 }
1049
1050
1051 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1052 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1053 pattern. */
1054
1055 static inline void
1056 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1057 {
1058 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1059
1060 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1061 {
1062 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1063 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1064 }
1065 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1066 {
1067 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1068 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1069 }
1070 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1071 {
1072 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1073 s->stippled_p = 0;
1074 }
1075 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1076 {
1077 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1078 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1079 }
1080 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1081 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1082 {
1083 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1084 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1085 }
1086 else
1087 {
1088 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1089 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1090 }
1091
1092 /* GC must have been set. */
1093 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1094 }
1095
1096
1097 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1098 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1099
1100 static inline void
1101 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1102 {
1103 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1104 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1105
1106 if (n > 0)
1107 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1108 s->num_clips = n;
1109 }
1110
1111
1112 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1113 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1114 the area of SRC. */
1115
1116 static void
1117 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1118 {
1119 XRectangle r;
1120
1121 r.x = src->x;
1122 r.width = src->width;
1123 r.y = src->y;
1124 r.height = src->height;
1125 dst->clip[0] = r;
1126 dst->num_clips = 1;
1127 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1128 }
1129
1130
1131 /* RIF:
1132 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1133
1134 static void
1135 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1136 {
1137 if (s->cmp == NULL
1138 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1139 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1140 {
1141 struct font_metrics metrics;
1142
1143 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1144 {
1145 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1146 struct font *font = s->font;
1147 int i;
1148
1149 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1150 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1151 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1152 }
1153 else
1154 {
1155 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1156
1157 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1158 }
1159 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1160 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1161 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1162 }
1163 else if (s->cmp)
1164 {
1165 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1166 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1167 }
1168 }
1169
1170
1171 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1172
1173 static inline void
1174 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1175 {
1176 XGCValues xgcv;
1177 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1178 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1179 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1180 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1181 }
1182
1183
1184 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1185 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1186 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1187 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1188 contains the first component of a composition. */
1189
1190 static void
1191 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1192 {
1193 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1194 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1195 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1196 {
1197 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1198
1199 if (s->stippled_p)
1200 {
1201 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1202 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1203 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1204 s->y + box_line_width,
1205 s->background_width,
1206 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1207 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1208 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1209 }
1210 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1211 || s->font_not_found_p
1212 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1213 || force_p)
1214 {
1215 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1216 s->background_width,
1217 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1218 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1219 }
1220 }
1221 }
1222
1223
1224 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1225
1226 static void
1227 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1228 {
1229 int i, x;
1230
1231 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1232 of S to the right of that box line. */
1233 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1234 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1235 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1236 else
1237 x = s->x;
1238
1239 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1240 loaded. */
1241 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1242 {
1243 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1244 {
1245 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1246 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1247 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1248 s->height - 1);
1249 x += g->pixel_width;
1250 }
1251 }
1252 else
1253 {
1254 struct font *font = s->font;
1255 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1256 int y;
1257
1258 if (font->vertical_centering)
1259 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1260
1261 y = s->ybase - boff;
1262 if (s->for_overlaps
1263 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1264 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1265 else
1266 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1267 if (s->face->overstrike)
1268 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1269 }
1270 }
1271
1272 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1273
1274 static void
1275 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1276 {
1277 int i, j, x;
1278 struct font *font = s->font;
1279
1280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1281 of S to the right of that box line. */
1282 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1284 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1285 else
1286 x = s->x;
1287
1288 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1289 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1290 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1291 this composition. */
1292
1293 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1294 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1295 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1296 {
1297 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1298 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1299 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1300 }
1301 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1302 {
1303 int y = s->ybase;
1304
1305 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1306 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1307 space on the left or right. */
1308 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1309 {
1310 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1311 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1312
1313 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1314 if (s->face->overstrike)
1315 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1316 }
1317 }
1318 else
1319 {
1320 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1321 Lisp_Object glyph;
1322 int y = s->ybase;
1323 int width = 0;
1324
1325 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1326 {
1327 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1328 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1329 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1330 else
1331 {
1332 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1333
1334 if (j < i)
1335 {
1336 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1337 if (s->face->overstrike)
1338 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1339 x += width;
1340 }
1341 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1342 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1343 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1344 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1345 if (s->face->overstrike)
1346 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1347 x += wadjust;
1348 j = i + 1;
1349 width = 0;
1350 }
1351 }
1352 if (j < i)
1353 {
1354 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1355 if (s->face->overstrike)
1356 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1357 }
1358 }
1359 }
1360
1361
1362 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1363
1364 static void
1365 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1366 {
1367 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1368 XChar2b char2b[8];
1369 int x, i, j;
1370
1371 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1372 of S to the right of that box line. */
1373 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1374 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1375 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1376 else
1377 x = s->x;
1378
1379 s->char2b = char2b;
1380
1381 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1382 {
1383 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1384 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1385
1386 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1387 {
1388 if (len > 0
1389 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1390 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1391 >= 1))
1392 {
1393 Lisp_Object acronym
1394 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1395 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1396 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1397 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1398 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1399 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1400 }
1401 }
1402 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1403 {
1404 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1405 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1406 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1407 str = buf;
1408 }
1409
1410 if (str)
1411 {
1412 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1413 unsigned code;
1414
1415 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1416 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1417 {
1418 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1419 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1420 }
1421 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1422 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1423 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1424 0);
1425 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1426 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1427 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1428 0);
1429 }
1430 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1431 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1432 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1433 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1434 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1435 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1436 }
1437 }
1438
1439 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1440
1441 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget (Widget);
1442 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1443 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1444 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1445 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1446
1447
1448 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1449 cannot be determined. */
1450
1451 static struct frame *
1452 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1453 {
1454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1455 Lisp_Object tail;
1456 struct frame *f;
1457
1458 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1459
1460 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1461 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1462 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1463 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1464 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1465 widget = XtParent (widget);
1466
1467 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1468 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1469 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1470 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1471 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1472 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1473 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1474 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1475 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1476 return f;
1477
1478 abort ();
1479 }
1480
1481
1482 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1483
1484 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1485 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1486 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1487 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1488 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1489 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1490
1491 int
1492 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1493 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1494 {
1495 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1496 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1497 }
1498
1499 #endif
1500
1501
1502 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1503 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1504
1505 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1506 {
1507 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1508 sizeof (Screen *)},
1509 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1510 sizeof (Colormap)}
1511 };
1512
1513
1514 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1515 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1516
1517 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1518
1519
1520 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1521
1522 DPY is the display we are working on.
1523
1524 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1525 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1526 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1527 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1528
1529 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1530 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1531
1532 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1533 we allocated the color or not.
1534
1535 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1536
1537 static Boolean
1538 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1539 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1540 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1541 {
1542 Screen *screen;
1543 Colormap cmap;
1544 Pixel pixel;
1545 String color_name;
1546 XColor color;
1547
1548 if (*nargs != 2)
1549 {
1550 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1551 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1552 "XtToolkitError",
1553 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1554 return False;
1555 }
1556
1557 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1558 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1559 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1560
1561 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1562 {
1563 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1564 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1565 }
1566 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1567 {
1568 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1569 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1570 }
1571 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1572 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1573 {
1574 pixel = color.pixel;
1575 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1576 }
1577 else
1578 {
1579 String params[1];
1580 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1581
1582 params[0] = color_name;
1583 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1584 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1585 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1586 params, &nparams);
1587 return False;
1588 }
1589
1590 if (to->addr != NULL)
1591 {
1592 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1593 {
1594 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1595 return False;
1596 }
1597
1598 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1599 }
1600 else
1601 {
1602 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1603 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1604 }
1605
1606 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1607 return True;
1608 }
1609
1610
1611 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1612 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1613 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1614
1615 APP is the application context in which we work.
1616
1617 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1618 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1619 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1620
1621 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1622
1623 static void
1624 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1625 Cardinal *nargs)
1626 {
1627 if (*nargs != 2)
1628 {
1629 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1630 "XtToolkitError",
1631 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1632 NULL, NULL);
1633 }
1634 else if (closure != NULL)
1635 {
1636 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1637 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1638 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1639 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1640 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1641 }
1642 }
1643
1644
1645 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1646
1647
1648 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1649 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1650 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1651 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1652
1653 static const XColor *
1654 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1655 {
1656 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1657
1658 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1659 {
1660 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1661 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1662 int i;
1663
1664 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1665 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1666 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1667
1668 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1669 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1670
1671 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1672 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1673 }
1674
1675 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1676 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1677 }
1678
1679
1680 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1681 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1682
1683 void
1684 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1685 {
1686 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1687
1688 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1689 {
1690 int i;
1691 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1692 {
1693 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1694 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1695 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1696 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1697 }
1698 }
1699 else
1700 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1701 }
1702
1703
1704 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1705 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1706
1707 void
1708 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1709 {
1710 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1711 }
1712
1713
1714 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1715 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1716 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1717 allocated. */
1718
1719 static int
1720 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1721 {
1722 int rc;
1723
1724 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1725 if (rc == 0)
1726 {
1727 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1728 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1729 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1730 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1731 int nearest, i;
1732 int max_color_delta = 255;
1733 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1734 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1735 int ncells;
1736 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1737
1738 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1739 {
1740 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1741 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1742 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1743 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1744
1745 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1746 {
1747 nearest = i;
1748 nearest_delta = delta;
1749 }
1750 }
1751
1752 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1753 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1754 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1755 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1756 }
1757 else
1758 {
1759 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1760 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1761 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1762 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1763 XColor *cached_color;
1764
1765 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1766 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1767 (cached_color->red != color->red
1768 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1769 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1770 {
1771 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1772 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1773 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1774 }
1775 }
1776
1777 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1778 if (rc)
1779 register_color (color->pixel);
1780 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1781
1782 return rc;
1783 }
1784
1785
1786 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1787 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1788 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1789 allocated. */
1790
1791 int
1792 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1793 {
1794 gamma_correct (f, color);
1795 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1796 }
1797
1798
1799 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1800 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1801 get color reference counts right. */
1802
1803 unsigned long
1804 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1805 {
1806 XColor color;
1807
1808 color.pixel = pixel;
1809 BLOCK_INPUT;
1810 x_query_color (f, &color);
1811 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1812 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1813 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1814 register_color (pixel);
1815 #endif
1816 return color.pixel;
1817 }
1818
1819
1820 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1821 boosted.
1822
1823 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1824 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1825 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1826 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1827 use an additional additive factor.
1828
1829 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1830 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1831 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1832
1833
1834 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1835 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1836 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1837 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1838 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1839 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1840
1841 static int
1842 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1843 {
1844 XColor color, new;
1845 long bright;
1846 int success_p;
1847
1848 /* Get RGB color values. */
1849 color.pixel = *pixel;
1850 x_query_color (f, &color);
1851
1852 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1853 eassert (factor >= 0);
1854 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1855 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1856 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1857
1858 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1859 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1860
1861 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1862 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1863 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1864 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1865 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1866 {
1867 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1868 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1869 /* The additive adjustment. */
1870 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1871
1872 if (factor < 1)
1873 {
1874 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1875 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1876 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1877 }
1878 else
1879 {
1880 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1881 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1882 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1883 }
1884 }
1885
1886 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1887 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1888 if (success_p)
1889 {
1890 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1891 {
1892 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1893 delta to the RGB values. */
1894 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1895
1896 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1897 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1898 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1899 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1900 }
1901 else
1902 success_p = 1;
1903 *pixel = new.pixel;
1904 }
1905
1906 return success_p;
1907 }
1908
1909
1910 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1911 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1912 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1913 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1914 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1915 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1916
1917 static void
1918 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1919 {
1920 XGCValues xgcv;
1921 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1922 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1923 unsigned long pixel;
1924 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1925 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1926 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1927 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1928
1929 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1930 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1931
1932 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1933 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1934 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1935 if (relief->gc
1936 && relief->allocated_p)
1937 {
1938 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1939 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1940 }
1941
1942 /* Allocate new color. */
1943 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1944 pixel = background;
1945 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1946 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1947 {
1948 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1949 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1950 }
1951
1952 if (relief->gc == 0)
1953 {
1954 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1955 mask |= GCStipple;
1956 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1957 }
1958 else
1959 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1960 }
1961
1962
1963 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1964
1965 static void
1966 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1967 {
1968 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1969 unsigned long color;
1970
1971 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1972 color = s->face->box_color;
1973 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1974 && s->img->pixmap
1975 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1976 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1977 else
1978 {
1979 XGCValues xgcv;
1980
1981 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1982 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1983 color = xgcv.background;
1984 }
1985
1986 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1987 || color != di->relief_background)
1988 {
1989 di->relief_background = color;
1990 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1991 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1992 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1993 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1994 }
1995 }
1996
1997
1998 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1999 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2000 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2001 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2002 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2003 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2004 when drawing. */
2005
2006 static void
2007 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
2008 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2009 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
2010 XRectangle *clip_rect)
2011 {
2012 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2013 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2014 int i;
2015 GC gc;
2016
2017 if (raised_p)
2018 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2019 else
2020 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2021 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2022
2023 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2024 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2025 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2026 corner pixels. */
2027
2028 /* Top. */
2029 if (top_p)
2030 {
2031 if (width == 1)
2032 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2033 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2034 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2035
2036 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2039 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2040 }
2041
2042 /* Left. */
2043 if (left_p)
2044 {
2045 if (width == 1)
2046 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2047
2048 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2049 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2050
2051 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2054 }
2055
2056 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2057 if (raised_p)
2058 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2059 else
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2061 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2062
2063 if (width > 1)
2064 {
2065 /* Outermost top line. */
2066 if (top_p)
2067 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2068 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2069 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2070
2071 /* Outermost left line. */
2072 if (left_p)
2073 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2074 }
2075
2076 /* Bottom. */
2077 if (bot_p)
2078 {
2079 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2080 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2081 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2082 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2083 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2084 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2085 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2086 }
2087
2088 /* Right. */
2089 if (right_p)
2090 {
2091 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2092 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2093 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2094 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2095 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2096 }
2097
2098 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2099 }
2100
2101
2102 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2103 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2104 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2105 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2106 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2107 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2108
2109 static void
2110 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2111 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2112 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2113 {
2114 XGCValues xgcv;
2115
2116 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2117 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2118 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2119
2120 /* Top. */
2121 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2122 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2123
2124 /* Left. */
2125 if (left_p)
2126 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2127 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2128
2129 /* Bottom. */
2130 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2131 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2132
2133 /* Right. */
2134 if (right_p)
2135 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2136 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2137
2138 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2139 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2140 }
2141
2142
2143 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2144
2145 static void
2146 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2147 {
2148 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2149 int left_p, right_p;
2150 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2151 XRectangle clip_rect;
2152
2153 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2154 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2155 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2156
2157 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2158 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2159 ? s->first_glyph
2160 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2161
2162 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2163 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2164 left_x = s->x;
2165 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2166 ? last_x - 1
2167 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2168 top_y = s->y;
2169 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2170
2171 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2172 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2173 && (s->prev == NULL
2174 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2175 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2176 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2177 && (s->next == NULL
2178 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2179
2180 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2181
2182 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2183 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2184 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2185 else
2186 {
2187 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2188 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2189 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2190 }
2191 }
2192
2193
2194 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2195
2196 static void
2197 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2198 {
2199 int x = s->x;
2200 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2201
2202 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2203 right of that line. */
2204 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2205 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2206 && s->slice.x == 0)
2207 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2208
2209 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2210 by that margin. */
2211 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2212 x += s->img->hmargin;
2213 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2214 y += s->img->vmargin;
2215
2216 if (s->img->pixmap)
2217 {
2218 if (s->img->mask)
2219 {
2220 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2221 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2222 trust on the shape extension to be available
2223 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2224 manually. */
2225 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2226 | GCFunction);
2227 XGCValues xgcv;
2228 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2229
2230 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2231 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2232 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2233 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2234 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2235
2236 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2237 image_rect.x = x;
2238 image_rect.y = y;
2239 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2240 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2241 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2242 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2243 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2244 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2245 }
2246 else
2247 {
2248 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2249
2250 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2251 image_rect.x = x;
2252 image_rect.y = y;
2253 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2254 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2255 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2256 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2257 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2258 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2259
2260 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2261 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2262 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2263 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2264 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2265 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2266 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2267 {
2268 int relief = s->img->relief;
2269 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2270 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2271 x - relief, y - relief,
2272 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2273 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2274 }
2275 }
2276 }
2277 else
2278 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2279 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2280 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2281 }
2282
2283
2284 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2285
2286 static void
2287 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2288 {
2289 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2290 int extra_x, extra_y;
2291 XRectangle r;
2292 int x = s->x;
2293 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2294
2295 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2296 right of that line. */
2297 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2298 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2299 && s->slice.x == 0)
2300 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2301
2302 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2303 by that margin. */
2304 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2305 x += s->img->hmargin;
2306 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2307 y += s->img->vmargin;
2308
2309 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2310 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2311 {
2312 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2313 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2314 }
2315 else
2316 {
2317 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2318 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2319 }
2320
2321 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2322 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2323 {
2324 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2325 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2326 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2327 {
2328 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2329 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2330 }
2331 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2332 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2333 }
2334
2335 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2336 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2337 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2338 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2339
2340 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2341 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2342 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2343 s->slice.y == 0,
2344 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2345 s->slice.x == 0,
2346 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2347 &r);
2348 }
2349
2350
2351 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2352
2353 static void
2354 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2355 {
2356 int x = 0;
2357 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2358
2359 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2360 right of that line. */
2361 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2362 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2363 && s->slice.x == 0)
2364 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2365
2366 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2367 by that margin. */
2368 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2369 x += s->img->hmargin;
2370 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2371 y += s->img->vmargin;
2372
2373 if (s->img->pixmap)
2374 {
2375 if (s->img->mask)
2376 {
2377 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2378 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2379 trust on the shape extension to be available
2380 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2381 manually. */
2382 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2383 | GCFunction);
2384 XGCValues xgcv;
2385
2386 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2387 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2388 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2389 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2390 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2391
2392 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2393 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2394 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2395 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2396 }
2397 else
2398 {
2399 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2400 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2401 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2402
2403 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2404 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2405 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2406 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2407 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2408 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2409 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2410 {
2411 int r = s->img->relief;
2412 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2413 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2414 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2415 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2416 }
2417 }
2418 }
2419 else
2420 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2421 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2422 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2423 }
2424
2425
2426 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2427 give the rectangle to draw. */
2428
2429 static void
2430 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2431 {
2432 if (s->stippled_p)
2433 {
2434 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2435 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2436 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2437 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2438 }
2439 else
2440 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2441 }
2442
2443
2444 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2445
2446 s->y
2447 s->x +-------------------------
2448 | s->face->box
2449 |
2450 | +-------------------------
2451 | | s->img->margin
2452 | |
2453 | | +-------------------
2454 | | | the image
2455
2456 */
2457
2458 static void
2459 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2460 {
2461 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2462 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2463 int height;
2464 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2465
2466 height = s->height;
2467 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2468 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2469 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2470 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2471
2472 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2473 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2474 flickering. */
2475 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2476 if (height > s->slice.height
2477 || s->img->hmargin
2478 || s->img->vmargin
2479 || s->img->mask
2480 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2481 || s->width != s->background_width)
2482 {
2483 if (s->img->mask)
2484 {
2485 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2486 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2487 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2488 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2489 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2490
2491 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2492 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2493 s->background_width,
2494 s->height, depth);
2495
2496 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2497 pixmap. */
2498 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2499
2500 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2501 if (s->stippled_p)
2502 {
2503 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2504 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2505 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2506 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2507 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2508 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2509 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2510 }
2511 else
2512 {
2513 XGCValues xgcv;
2514 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2515 &xgcv);
2516 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2517 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2518 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2519 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2520 }
2521 }
2522 else
2523 {
2524 int x = s->x;
2525 int y = s->y;
2526
2527 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2528 && s->slice.x == 0)
2529 x += box_line_hwidth;
2530
2531 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2532 y += box_line_vwidth;
2533
2534 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2535 }
2536
2537 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2538 }
2539
2540 /* Draw the foreground. */
2541 if (pixmap != None)
2542 {
2543 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2544 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2545 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2546 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2547 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2548 }
2549 else
2550 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2551
2552 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2553 if (s->img->relief
2554 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2555 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2556 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2557 }
2558
2559
2560 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2561
2562 static void
2563 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2564 {
2565 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2566
2567 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2568 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2569 {
2570 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2571 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2572 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2573 int x = s->x;
2574
2575 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2576 {
2577 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2578
2579 if (x < left_x)
2580 {
2581 background_width -= left_x - x;
2582 x = left_x;
2583 }
2584 }
2585 else
2586 {
2587 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2588 stretch glyph. */
2589 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2590
2591 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2592 background_width -= x - right_x;
2593 x += background_width;
2594 }
2595 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2596 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2597 x -= width;
2598
2599 /* Draw cursor. */
2600 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2601
2602 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2603 if (width < background_width)
2604 {
2605 int y = s->y;
2606 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2607 XRectangle r;
2608 GC gc;
2609
2610 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2611 x += width;
2612 else
2613 x = s->x;
2614 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2615 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2616 {
2617 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2618 gc = s->gc;
2619 }
2620 else
2621 gc = s->face->gc;
2622
2623 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2624 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2625
2626 if (s->face->stipple)
2627 {
2628 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2629 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2630 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2631 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2632 }
2633 else
2634 {
2635 XGCValues xgcv;
2636 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2637 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2638 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2639 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2640 }
2641 }
2642 }
2643 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2644 {
2645 int background_width = s->background_width;
2646 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2647
2648 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2649 except for header line and mode line. */
2650 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2651 {
2652 background_width -= left_x - x;
2653 x = left_x;
2654 }
2655 if (background_width > 0)
2656 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2657 }
2658
2659 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2660 }
2661
2662 /*
2663 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2664
2665 x0 wave_length = 2
2666 --
2667 y0 * * * * *
2668 |* * * * * * * * *
2669 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2670
2671 */
2672
2673 static void
2674 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2675 {
2676 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2677 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2678 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2679
2680 dx = wave_length;
2681 dy = wave_height - 1;
2682 x0 = s->x;
2683 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2684 width = s->width;
2685 xmax = x0 + width;
2686
2687 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2688
2689 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2690 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2691
2692 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2693 return;
2694
2695 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2696
2697 /* Draw the waves */
2698
2699 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2700 x2 = x1 + dx;
2701 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2702 y1 = y2 = y0;
2703
2704 if (odd)
2705 y1 += dy;
2706 else
2707 y2 += dy;
2708
2709 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2710 abort ();
2711
2712 while (x1 <= xmax)
2713 {
2714 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2715 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2716 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2717 odd = !odd;
2718 }
2719
2720 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2721 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2722 }
2723
2724
2725 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2726
2727 static void
2728 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2729 {
2730 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2731
2732 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2733 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2734 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2735 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2736 {
2737 int width;
2738 struct glyph_string *next;
2739
2740 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2741 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2742 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2743 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2744 {
2745 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2746 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2747 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2748 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2749 else
2750 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2751 next->num_clips = 0;
2752 }
2753 }
2754
2755 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2756 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2757
2758 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2759 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2760 if (!s->for_overlaps
2761 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2762 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2763 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2764
2765 {
2766 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2767 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2768 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2769 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2770 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2771 }
2772 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2773 && !s->clip_tail
2774 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2775 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2776 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2777 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2778 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2779 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2780 else
2781 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2782
2783 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2784 {
2785 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2786 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2787 break;
2788
2789 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2790 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2791 break;
2792
2793 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2794 if (s->for_overlaps)
2795 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2796 else
2797 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2798 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2799 break;
2800
2801 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2802 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2803 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2804 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2805 else
2806 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2807 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2808 break;
2809
2810 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2811 if (s->for_overlaps)
2812 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2813 else
2814 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2815 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2816 break;
2817
2818 default:
2819 abort ();
2820 }
2821
2822 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2823 {
2824 /* Draw underline. */
2825 if (s->face->underline_p)
2826 {
2827 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2828 {
2829 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2830 x_draw_underwave (s);
2831 else
2832 {
2833 XGCValues xgcv;
2834 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2835 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2836 x_draw_underwave (s);
2837 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2838 }
2839 }
2840 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2841 {
2842 unsigned long thickness, position;
2843 int y;
2844
2845 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2846 {
2847 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2848 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2849 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2850 }
2851 else
2852 {
2853 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2854 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2855 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2856 else
2857 thickness = 1;
2858 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2859 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2860 else
2861 {
2862 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2863 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2864 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2865 specs, and its default is
2866
2867 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2868 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2869
2870 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2871 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2872 position = s->font->underline_position;
2873 else if (s->font)
2874 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2875 else
2876 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2877 }
2878 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2879 }
2880 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2881 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2882 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2883 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2884 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2885 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2886 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2887 s->underline_position = position;
2888 y = s->ybase + position;
2889 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2890 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2891 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2892 else
2893 {
2894 XGCValues xgcv;
2895 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2897 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2898 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2899 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2900 }
2901 }
2902 }
2903 /* Draw overline. */
2904 if (s->face->overline_p)
2905 {
2906 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2907
2908 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2909 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2910 s->width, h);
2911 else
2912 {
2913 XGCValues xgcv;
2914 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2915 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2916 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2917 s->width, h);
2918 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2919 }
2920 }
2921
2922 /* Draw strike-through. */
2923 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2924 {
2925 unsigned long h = 1;
2926 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2927
2928 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2929 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2930 s->width, h);
2931 else
2932 {
2933 XGCValues xgcv;
2934 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2935 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2936 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2937 s->width, h);
2938 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2939 }
2940 }
2941
2942 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2943 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2944 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2945
2946 if (s->prev)
2947 {
2948 struct glyph_string *prev;
2949
2950 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2951 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2952 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2953 {
2954 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2955 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2956 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2957
2958 prev->hl = s->hl;
2959 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2960 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2961 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2962 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2963 else
2964 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2965 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2966 prev->hl = save;
2967 prev->num_clips = 0;
2968 }
2969 }
2970
2971 if (s->next)
2972 {
2973 struct glyph_string *next;
2974
2975 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2976 if (next->hl != s->hl
2977 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2978 {
2979 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2980 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2981 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2982
2983 next->hl = s->hl;
2984 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2985 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2986 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2987 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2988 else
2989 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2990 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2991 next->hl = save;
2992 next->num_clips = 0;
2993 }
2994 }
2995 }
2996
2997 /* Reset clipping. */
2998 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2999 s->num_clips = 0;
3000 }
3001
3002 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
3003
3004 static void
3005 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
3006 {
3007 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3008 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3009 x, y, width, height,
3010 x + shift_by, y);
3011 }
3012
3013 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3014 for X frames. */
3015
3016 static void
3017 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3018 {
3019 abort ();
3020 }
3021
3022
3023 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3024 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3025
3026 void
3027 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3028 {
3029 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3030 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3031 }
3032
3033
3034 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3035
3036 static void
3037 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3038 {
3039 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3040 longer visible. */
3041 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3042 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3043 output_cursor.x = -1;
3044
3045 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3046 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3047 BLOCK_INPUT;
3048
3049 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3050
3051 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3052 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3053 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3054
3055 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3056 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3057 redisplay, do it here. */
3058 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3059 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3060 #endif
3061
3062 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3063
3064 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3065 }
3066
3067
3068 \f
3069 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3070
3071 static void
3072 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3073 {
3074 BLOCK_INPUT;
3075
3076 {
3077 #ifdef USE_GTK
3078 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3079 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3080 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3081 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3082 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3083 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3084 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3085 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3086 do { \
3087 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3088 cairo_fill (cr); \
3089 } \
3090 while (0)
3091 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3092 GdkGCValues vals;
3093 GdkGC *gc;
3094 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3095 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3096 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3097 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3098 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3099 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3100 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3101 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3102 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3103 GC gc;
3104
3105 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3106 pixels into background pixels. */
3107 {
3108 XGCValues values;
3109
3110 values.function = GXxor;
3111 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3112 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3113
3114 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3115 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3116 }
3117 #endif
3118 {
3119 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3120 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3121 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3122 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3123 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3124 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3125 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3126
3127 int width;
3128
3129 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3130 edge it is next to. */
3131 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3132 {
3133 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3134 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3135 break;
3136
3137 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3138 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3139 break;
3140
3141 default:
3142 break;
3143 }
3144
3145 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3146
3147 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3148 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3149 {
3150 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3151 flash_left,
3152 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3153 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3154 width, flash_height);
3155 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3156 flash_left,
3157 (height - flash_height
3158 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3159 width, flash_height);
3160
3161 }
3162 else
3163 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3164 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3165 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3166 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3167
3168 x_flush (f);
3169
3170 {
3171 EMACS_TIME wakeup, delay;
3172
3173 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3174 EMACS_SET_SECS_NSECS (delay, 0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3175 EMACS_ADD_TIME (wakeup, wakeup, delay);
3176
3177 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3178 available. */
3179 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3180 {
3181 EMACS_TIME current, timeout;
3182
3183 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3184
3185 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3186 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3187 break;
3188
3189 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3190 EMACS_SET_SECS_NSECS (timeout, 0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3191
3192 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3193 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3194 }
3195 }
3196
3197 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3198 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3199 {
3200 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3201 flash_left,
3202 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3203 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3204 width, flash_height);
3205 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3206 flash_left,
3207 (height - flash_height
3208 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3209 width, flash_height);
3210 }
3211 else
3212 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3213 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3214 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3215 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3216
3217 #ifdef USE_GTK
3218 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3219 cairo_destroy (cr);
3220 #else
3221 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3222 #endif
3223 #undef XFillRectangle
3224 #else
3225 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3226 #endif
3227 x_flush (f);
3228 }
3229 }
3230
3231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3232 }
3233
3234
3235 static void
3236 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3237 {
3238 BLOCK_INPUT;
3239 if (invisible)
3240 {
3241 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3242 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3243 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3244 }
3245 else
3246 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3247 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3248 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3250 }
3251
3252
3253 /* Make audible bell. */
3254
3255 static void
3256 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3257 {
3258 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3259 {
3260 if (visible_bell)
3261 XTflash (f);
3262 else
3263 {
3264 BLOCK_INPUT;
3265 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3266 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3267 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3268 }
3269 }
3270 }
3271
3272 \f
3273 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3274 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3275 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3276 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3277
3278 static void
3279 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3280 {
3281 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3282 }
3283
3284
3285 \f
3286 /***********************************************************************
3287 Line Dance
3288 ***********************************************************************/
3289
3290 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3291 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3292
3293 static void
3294 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3295 {
3296 abort ();
3297 }
3298
3299
3300 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3301
3302 static void
3303 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3304 {
3305 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3306 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3307
3308 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3309 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3310 fringe of W. */
3311 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3312
3313 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3314 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3315 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3316 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3317 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3318 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3319 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3320 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3321 {
3322 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3323
3324 if (sb_width > 0)
3325 {
3326 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3327 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3328 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3329
3330 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3331 {
3332 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3333 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3334 }
3335 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3336 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3337 }
3338 }
3339 #endif
3340
3341 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3342 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3343 bottom_y = y + height;
3344
3345 if (to_y < from_y)
3346 {
3347 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3348 line at the bottom. */
3349 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3350 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3351 else
3352 height = run->height;
3353 }
3354 else
3355 {
3356 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3357 at the bottom. */
3358 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3359 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3360 else
3361 height = run->height;
3362 }
3363
3364 BLOCK_INPUT;
3365
3366 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3367 updated_window = w;
3368 x_clear_cursor (w);
3369
3370 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3371 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3372 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3373 x, from_y,
3374 width, height,
3375 x, to_y);
3376
3377 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3378 }
3379
3380
3381 \f
3382 /***********************************************************************
3383 Exposure Events
3384 ***********************************************************************/
3385
3386 \f
3387 static void
3388 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3389 {
3390 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3391 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3392 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3393 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3394 BLOCK_INPUT;
3395 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3396 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3397 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3398 because of this (bug#9310). */
3399 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3400 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3401 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3402 x_uncatch_errors ();
3403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3404 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3405 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3406 }
3407
3408 static void
3409 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3410 {
3411 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3412 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3413 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3414 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3415 BLOCK_INPUT;
3416 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3417 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3418 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3419 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3420 x_uncatch_errors ();
3421 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3422 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3423 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3424 }
3425
3426 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3427 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3428 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3429 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3430 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3431
3432 static void
3433 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3434 {
3435 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3436
3437 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3438 {
3439 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3440 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3441 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3442
3443 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3444 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3445
3446 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3447 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3448 else
3449 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3450 }
3451
3452 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3453 }
3454
3455 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3456 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3457 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3458
3459 static void
3460 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3461 {
3462 if (type == FocusIn)
3463 {
3464 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3465 {
3466 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3467 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3468
3469 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3470 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3471 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3472 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3473 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3474 {
3475 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3476 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3477 }
3478 }
3479
3480 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3481
3482 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3483 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3484 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3485 #endif
3486 }
3487 else if (type == FocusOut)
3488 {
3489 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3490
3491 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3492 {
3493 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3494 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3495 }
3496
3497 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3498 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3499 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3500 #endif
3501 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3502 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3503 }
3504 }
3505
3506 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3507 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3508
3509 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3510
3511 static void
3512 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3513 {
3514 struct frame *frame;
3515
3516 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3517 if (! frame)
3518 return;
3519
3520 switch (event->type)
3521 {
3522 case EnterNotify:
3523 case LeaveNotify:
3524 {
3525 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3526 int focus_state
3527 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3528
3529 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3530 && event->xcrossing.focus
3531 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3532 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3533 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3534 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3535 }
3536 break;
3537
3538 case FocusIn:
3539 case FocusOut:
3540 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3541 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3542 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3543 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3544 break;
3545
3546 case ClientMessage:
3547 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3548 {
3549 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3550 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3551 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3552 }
3553 break;
3554 }
3555 }
3556
3557
3558 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3559 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3560
3561 void
3562 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3563 {
3564 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3565 }
3566 #endif
3567
3568 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3569 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3570 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3571
3572 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3573 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3574 the appropriate X display info. */
3575
3576 static void
3577 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3578 {
3579 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3580 }
3581
3582 static void
3583 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3584 {
3585 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3586
3587 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3588 {
3589 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3590 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3591 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3592 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3593 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3594 {
3595 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3596 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3597 }
3598 }
3599 else
3600 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3601
3602 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3603 {
3604 if (old_highlight)
3605 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3606 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3607 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3608 }
3609 }
3610
3611
3612 \f
3613 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3614
3615 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3616 static void
3617 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3618 {
3619 int min_code, max_code;
3620 KeySym *syms;
3621 int syms_per_code;
3622 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3623
3624 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3625 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3626 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3627 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3628 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3629
3630 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3631
3632 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3633 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3634 &syms_per_code);
3635 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3636
3637 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3638 Alt keysyms are on. */
3639 {
3640 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3641 int found_alt_or_meta;
3642
3643 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3644 {
3645 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3646 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3647 {
3648 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3649
3650 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3651 if (code == 0)
3652 continue;
3653
3654 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3655 {
3656 int code_col;
3657
3658 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3659 {
3660 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3661
3662 switch (sym)
3663 {
3664 case XK_Meta_L:
3665 case XK_Meta_R:
3666 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3667 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3668 break;
3669
3670 case XK_Alt_L:
3671 case XK_Alt_R:
3672 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3673 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3674 break;
3675
3676 case XK_Hyper_L:
3677 case XK_Hyper_R:
3678 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3679 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3680 code_col = syms_per_code;
3681 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3682 break;
3683
3684 case XK_Super_L:
3685 case XK_Super_R:
3686 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3687 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3688 code_col = syms_per_code;
3689 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3690 break;
3691
3692 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3693 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3694 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3695 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3696 code_col = syms_per_code;
3697 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3698 break;
3699 }
3700 }
3701 }
3702 }
3703 }
3704 }
3705
3706 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3707 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3708 {
3709 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3710 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3711 }
3712
3713 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3714 make them just meta, not alt. */
3715 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3716 {
3717 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3718 }
3719
3720 XFree ((char *) syms);
3721 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3722 }
3723
3724 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3725 Emacs uses. */
3726
3727 int
3728 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3729 {
3730 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3731 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3732 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3733 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3734 Lisp_Object tem;
3735
3736 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3737 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3738 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3739 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3740 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3741 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3742 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3743 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3744
3745 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3746 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3747 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3748 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3749 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3750 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3751 }
3752
3753 static int
3754 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3755 {
3756 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3757 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3758 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3759 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3760
3761 Lisp_Object tem;
3762
3763 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3764 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3765 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3766 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3767 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3768 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3769 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3770 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3771
3772
3773 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3774 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3775 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3776 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3777 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3778 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3779 }
3780
3781 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3782
3783 char *
3784 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3785 {
3786 char *value;
3787
3788 BLOCK_INPUT;
3789 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3790 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3791
3792 return value;
3793 }
3794
3795
3796 \f
3797 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3798
3799 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3800
3801 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3802 the mouse. */
3803
3804 static Lisp_Object
3805 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3806 {
3807 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3808 otherwise. */
3809 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3810 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3811 result->timestamp = event->time;
3812 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3813 event->state)
3814 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3815 ? up_modifier
3816 : down_modifier));
3817
3818 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3819 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3820 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3821 result->arg = Qnil;
3822 return Qnil;
3823 }
3824
3825 \f
3826 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3827 The input handler calls this.
3828
3829 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3830 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3831 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3832 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3833
3834 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3835 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3836
3837 static int
3838 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3839 {
3840 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3841 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3842 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3843
3844 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3845 return 0;
3846
3847 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3848 {
3849 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3850 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3851 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3852 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3853 return 1;
3854 }
3855
3856
3857 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3858 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3859 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3860 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3861 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3862 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3863 {
3864 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3865 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3866 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3867 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3868 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3869 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3870 return 1;
3871 }
3872
3873 return 0;
3874 }
3875
3876 \f
3877 /************************************************************************
3878 Mouse Face
3879 ************************************************************************/
3880
3881 static void
3882 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3883 {
3884 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3885 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3886 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3887 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3888 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3889 }
3890
3891
3892
3893 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3894 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3895
3896 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3897 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3898 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3899 position on the scroll bar.
3900
3901 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3902 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3903 the mouse is over.
3904
3905 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3906 was at this position.
3907
3908 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3909
3910 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3911 movement. */
3912
3913 static void
3914 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3915 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3916 Time *timestamp)
3917 {
3918 FRAME_PTR f1;
3919
3920 BLOCK_INPUT;
3921
3922 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3923 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3924 else
3925 {
3926 Window root;
3927 int root_x, root_y;
3928
3929 Window dummy_window;
3930 int dummy;
3931
3932 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3933
3934 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3935 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3936 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3937 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3938 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3939
3940 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3941
3942 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3943 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3944 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3945
3946 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3947 &root,
3948
3949 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3950 a different screen. */
3951 &dummy_window,
3952
3953 /* The position on that root window. */
3954 &root_x, &root_y,
3955
3956 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3957 &dummy, &dummy,
3958
3959 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3960 we don't care. */
3961 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3962
3963 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3964 containing the pointer. */
3965 {
3966 Window win, child;
3967 int win_x, win_y;
3968 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3969
3970 win = root;
3971
3972 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3973 structure is changing at the same time this function
3974 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3975
3976 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3977
3978 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3979 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3980 {
3981 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3982 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3983 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3984
3985 /* From-window, to-window. */
3986 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3987
3988 /* From-position, to-position. */
3989 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3990
3991 /* Child of win. */
3992 &child);
3993 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3994 }
3995 else
3996 {
3997 while (1)
3998 {
3999 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
4000
4001 /* From-window, to-window. */
4002 root, win,
4003
4004 /* From-position, to-position. */
4005 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
4006
4007 /* Child of win. */
4008 &child);
4009
4010 if (child == None || child == win)
4011 break;
4012 #ifdef USE_GTK
4013 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4014 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
4015 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
4016 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
4017 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
4018 break;
4019 #endif
4020 win = child;
4021 parent_x = win_x;
4022 parent_y = win_y;
4023 }
4024
4025 /* Now we know that:
4026 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4027 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4028 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4029 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4030 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4031 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4032 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4033 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4034 never use them in that case.) */
4035
4036 #ifdef USE_GTK
4037 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4038 want the edit window. */
4039 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4040 #else
4041 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4042 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4043 #endif
4044
4045 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4046 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4047 on the frame. */
4048 if (f1 != NULL
4049 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4050 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4051 f1 = NULL;
4052 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4053 }
4054
4055 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4056 f1 = 0;
4057
4058 x_uncatch_errors ();
4059
4060 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4061 if (! f1)
4062 {
4063 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4064
4065 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4066
4067 if (bar)
4068 {
4069 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4070 win_x = parent_x;
4071 win_y = parent_y;
4072 }
4073 }
4074
4075 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4076 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4077
4078 if (f1)
4079 {
4080 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4081 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4082 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4083 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4084 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4085 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4086 the frame are divided into. */
4087
4088 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4089 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4090
4091 *bar_window = Qnil;
4092 *part = 0;
4093 *fp = f1;
4094 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4095 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4096 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4097 }
4098 }
4099 }
4100
4101 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4102 }
4103
4104
4105 \f
4106 /***********************************************************************
4107 Scroll bars
4108 ***********************************************************************/
4109
4110 /* Scroll bar support. */
4111
4112 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4113 manages it.
4114 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4115 bits. */
4116
4117 static struct scroll_bar *
4118 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4119 {
4120 Lisp_Object tail;
4121
4122 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4123 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4124 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4125
4126 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4127 {
4128 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4129
4130 frame = XCAR (tail);
4131 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4132 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4133 abort ();
4134
4135 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4136 continue;
4137
4138 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4139 right window ID. */
4140 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4141 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4142 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4143 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4144 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4145 condemned = Qnil,
4146 ! NILP (bar));
4147 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4148 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4149 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4150 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4151 }
4152
4153 return NULL;
4154 }
4155
4156
4157 #if defined USE_LUCID
4158
4159 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4160 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4161
4162 static Widget
4163 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4164 {
4165 Lisp_Object tail;
4166
4167 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4168 {
4169 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4170 {
4171 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4172 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4173
4174 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4175 return menu_bar;
4176 }
4177 }
4178
4179 return NULL;
4180 }
4181
4182 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4183
4184 \f
4185 /************************************************************************
4186 Toolkit scroll bars
4187 ************************************************************************/
4188
4189 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4190
4191 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4192 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4193 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4194 struct scroll_bar *);
4195 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4196 int, int, int);
4197
4198
4199 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4200 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4201
4202 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4203
4204 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4205
4206 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4207
4208 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4209 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4210
4211 #ifndef USE_GTK
4212 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4213
4214 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4215
4216 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4217
4218 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4219 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4220 to avoid jerkiness. */
4221
4222 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4223
4224 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4225 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4226 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4227 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4228
4229 static void
4230 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4231 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4232 {
4233 int scroll_bar_p;
4234 const char *end_action;
4235
4236 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4237 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4238 end_action = "Release";
4239 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4240 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4241 end_action = "EndScroll";
4242 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4243
4244 if (scroll_bar_p
4245 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4246 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4247 {
4248 struct window *w;
4249
4250 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4251 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4252 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4253
4254 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4255 {
4256 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4257 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4258 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4259 }
4260 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4261 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4262
4263 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4264 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4265 }
4266 }
4267 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4268
4269 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4270 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4271
4272 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4273 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4274
4275
4276 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4277 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4278 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4279 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4280
4281 static void
4282 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4283 {
4284 XEvent event;
4285 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4286 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4287 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4288 ptrdiff_t i;
4289
4290 BLOCK_INPUT;
4291
4292 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4293 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4294 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4295 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4296 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4297 ev->format = 32;
4298
4299 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4300 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4301 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4302 into that array in the event. */
4303 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4304 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4305 break;
4306
4307 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4308 {
4309 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4310 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4311 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4312 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4313 scroll_bar_windows =
4314 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4315 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4316 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4317 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4318 }
4319
4320 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4321 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4322 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4323 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4324 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4325 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4326
4327 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4328 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4329 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4330 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4331 #endif
4332
4333 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4334 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4335 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4336 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4338 }
4339
4340
4341 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4342 in *IEVENT. */
4343
4344 static void
4345 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4346 {
4347 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4348 Lisp_Object window;
4349 struct window *w;
4350
4351 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4352 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4353
4354 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4355
4356 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4357 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4358 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4359 #ifdef USE_GTK
4360 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4361 #else
4362 ievent->timestamp =
4363 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4364 #endif
4365 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4366 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4367 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4368 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4369 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4370 }
4371
4372
4373 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4374
4375 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4376
4377 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4378
4379
4380 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4381 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4382 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4383
4384 static void
4385 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4386 {
4387 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4388 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4389 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4390
4391 switch (cs->reason)
4392 {
4393 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4394 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4395 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4396 break;
4397
4398 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4399 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4400 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4401 break;
4402
4403 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4404 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4405 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4406 break;
4407
4408 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4409 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4410 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4411 break;
4412
4413 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4414 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4415 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4416 break;
4417
4418 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4419 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4420 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4421 break;
4422
4423 case XmCR_DRAG:
4424 {
4425 int slider_size;
4426
4427 /* Get the slider size. */
4428 BLOCK_INPUT;
4429 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4430 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4431
4432 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4433 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4434 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4435 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4436 }
4437 break;
4438
4439 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4440 break;
4441 };
4442
4443 if (part >= 0)
4444 {
4445 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4446 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4447 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4448 }
4449 }
4450
4451 #elif defined USE_GTK
4452
4453 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4454 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4455
4456 static gboolean
4457 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4458 GtkScrollType scroll,
4459 gdouble value,
4460 gpointer user_data)
4461 {
4462 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4463 gdouble position;
4464 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4465 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4466 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4467
4468 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4469 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4470
4471
4472 switch (scroll)
4473 {
4474 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4475 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4476 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4477 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4478 {
4479 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4480 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4481 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4482 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4483 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4484 }
4485 break;
4486 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4487 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4488 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4489 break;
4490 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4491 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4492 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4493 break;
4494 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4495 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4496 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4497 break;
4498 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4499 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4500 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4501 break;
4502 }
4503
4504 if (part >= 0)
4505 {
4506 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4507 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4508 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4509 }
4510
4511 return FALSE;
4512 }
4513
4514 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4515
4516 static gboolean
4517 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4518 GdkEventButton *event,
4519 gpointer user_data)
4520 {
4521 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4522 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4523 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4524 {
4525 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4526 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4527 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4528 }
4529
4530 return FALSE;
4531 }
4532
4533
4534 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4535
4536 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4537 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4538 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4539 the thumb is. */
4540
4541 static void
4542 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4543 {
4544 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4545 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4546 float shown;
4547 int whole, portion, height;
4548 int part;
4549
4550 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4551 BLOCK_INPUT;
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4553 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4554
4555 whole = 10000000;
4556 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4557
4558 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4559 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4560 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4561 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4562 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4563 bottom). */
4564 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4565 else
4566 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4567
4568 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4569 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4570 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4571 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4572 }
4573
4574
4575 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4576 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4577 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4578 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4579 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4580 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4581 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4582
4583 static void
4584 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4585 {
4586 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4587 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4588 int position = (long) call_data;
4589 Dimension height;
4590 int part;
4591
4592 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4593 BLOCK_INPUT;
4594 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4595 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4596
4597 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4598 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4599
4600 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4601 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4602 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4603 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4604 else
4605 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4606
4607 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4608 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4609 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4610 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4611 }
4612
4613 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4614
4615 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4616
4617 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4618 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4619
4620 #ifdef USE_GTK
4621 static void
4622 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4623 {
4624 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4625
4626 BLOCK_INPUT;
4627 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4628 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4629 scroll_bar_name);
4630 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4631 }
4632
4633 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4634
4635 static void
4636 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4637 {
4638 Window xwindow;
4639 Widget widget;
4640 Arg av[20];
4641 int ac = 0;
4642 char const *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4643 unsigned long pixel;
4644
4645 BLOCK_INPUT;
4646
4647 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4648 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4649 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4650 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4651 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4652 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4653 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4654 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4655 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4656
4657 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4658 if (pixel != -1)
4659 {
4660 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4661 ++ac;
4662 }
4663
4664 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4665 if (pixel != -1)
4666 {
4667 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4668 ++ac;
4669 }
4670
4671 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4672 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4673
4674 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4675 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4676 (XtPointer) bar);
4677 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4678 (XtPointer) bar);
4679 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4680 (XtPointer) bar);
4681 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4682 (XtPointer) bar);
4683 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4684 (XtPointer) bar);
4685 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4686 (XtPointer) bar);
4687 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4688 (XtPointer) bar);
4689
4690 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4691 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4692
4693 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4694 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4695 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4696 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4697
4698 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4699
4700 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4701 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4702 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4703 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4704 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4705 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4706 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4707 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4708
4709 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4710 if (pixel != -1)
4711 {
4712 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4713 ++ac;
4714 }
4715
4716 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4717 if (pixel != -1)
4718 {
4719 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4720 ++ac;
4721 }
4722
4723 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4724
4725 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4726 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4727 {
4728 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4729 if (pixel != -1)
4730 {
4731 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4732 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4733 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4734 pixel = -1;
4735 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4736 }
4737 }
4738 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4739 {
4740 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4741 if (pixel != -1)
4742 {
4743 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4744 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4745 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4746 pixel = -1;
4747 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4748 }
4749 }
4750
4751 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4752 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4753 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4754 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4755 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4756 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4757 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4758 colors itself. */
4759 {
4760 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4761 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4762 ++ac;
4763 }
4764 else
4765 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4766 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4767 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4768 {
4769 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4770 the shadows. */
4771 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4772 ++ac;
4773
4774 /* Specify the colors. */
4775 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4776 if (pixel != -1)
4777 {
4778 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4779 ++ac;
4780 }
4781 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4782 if (pixel != -1)
4783 {
4784 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4785 ++ac;
4786 }
4787 }
4788 #endif
4789
4790 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4791 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4792
4793 {
4794 char const *initial = "";
4795 char const *val = initial;
4796 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4797 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4798 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4799 #endif
4800 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4801 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4802 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4803 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4804 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4805 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4806 }
4807 }
4808
4809 /* Define callbacks. */
4810 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4811 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4812 (XtPointer) bar);
4813
4814 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4815 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4816
4817 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4818
4819 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4820 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4821 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4822 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4823
4824 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4825 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4826 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4827 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4828
4829 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4830 }
4831 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4832
4833
4834 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4835 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4836
4837 #ifdef USE_GTK
4838 static void
4839 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4840 {
4841 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4842 }
4843
4844 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4845 static void
4846 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4847 int whole)
4848 {
4849 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4850 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4851 float top, shown;
4852
4853 BLOCK_INPUT;
4854
4855 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4856
4857 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4858 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4859 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4860 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4861 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4862 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4863 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4864 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4865 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4866 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4867 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4868 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4869 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4870 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4871 whole += portion;
4872
4873 if (whole <= 0)
4874 top = 0, shown = 1;
4875 else
4876 {
4877 top = (float) position / whole;
4878 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4879 }
4880
4881 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4882 {
4883 int size, value;
4884
4885 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4886 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4887 value. */
4888 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4889 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4890 size = max (size, 1);
4891
4892 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4893 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4894 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4895
4896 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4897 }
4898 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4899
4900 if (whole == 0)
4901 top = 0, shown = 1;
4902 else
4903 {
4904 top = (float) position / whole;
4905 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4906 }
4907
4908 {
4909 float old_top, old_shown;
4910 Dimension height;
4911 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4912 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4913 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4914 XtNheight, &height,
4915 NULL);
4916
4917 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4918 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4919 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4920 else
4921 top = old_top;
4922 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4923 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4924
4925 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4926 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4927 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4928 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4929 {
4930 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4931 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4932 else
4933 {
4934 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4935 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4936 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4937
4938 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4939 }
4940 }
4941 }
4942 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4943
4944 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4945 }
4946 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4947
4948 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4949
4950
4951 \f
4952 /************************************************************************
4953 Scroll bars, general
4954 ************************************************************************/
4955
4956 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4957 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4958 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4959 scroll bar. */
4960
4961 static struct scroll_bar *
4962 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4963 {
4964 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4965 struct scroll_bar *bar
4966 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4967
4968 BLOCK_INPUT;
4969
4970 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4971 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4972 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4973 {
4974 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4975 unsigned long mask;
4976 Window window;
4977
4978 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4979 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4980 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4981
4982 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4983 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4984 | ExposureMask);
4985 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4986
4987 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4988
4989 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4990 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4991 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4992 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4993 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4994 left, top, width,
4995 window_box_height (w), False);
4996
4997 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4998 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4999 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5000 top,
5001 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5002 height,
5003 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
5004 0,
5005 CopyFromParent,
5006 CopyFromParent,
5007 CopyFromParent,
5008 /* Attributes. */
5009 mask, &a);
5010 bar->x_window = window;
5011 }
5012 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5013
5014 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
5015 bar->top = top;
5016 bar->left = left;
5017 bar->width = width;
5018 bar->height = height;
5019 bar->start = 0;
5020 bar->end = 0;
5021 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5022 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5023
5024 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5025 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5026 bar->prev = Qnil;
5027 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5028 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5029 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5030
5031 /* Map the window/widget. */
5032 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5033 {
5034 #ifdef USE_GTK
5035 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5036 bar->x_window,
5037 top,
5038 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5039 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5040 max (height, 1));
5041 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5042 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5043 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5044 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5045 top,
5046 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5047 max (height, 1), 0);
5048 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5049 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5050 }
5051 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5052 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5053 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5054
5055 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5056 return bar;
5057 }
5058
5059
5060 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5061
5062 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5063
5064 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5065 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5066 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5067 events.)
5068
5069 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5070 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5071 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5072 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5073 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5074
5075 static void
5076 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5077 {
5078 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5079 Window w = bar->x_window;
5080 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5081 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5082
5083 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5084 if (! rebuild
5085 && start == bar->start
5086 && end == bar->end)
5087 return;
5088
5089 BLOCK_INPUT;
5090
5091 {
5092 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5093 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5094 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5095
5096 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5097 the distance between start and end. */
5098 {
5099 int length = end - start;
5100
5101 if (start < 0)
5102 start = 0;
5103 else if (start > top_range)
5104 start = top_range;
5105 end = start + length;
5106
5107 if (end < start)
5108 end = start;
5109 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5110 end = top_range;
5111 }
5112
5113 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5114 bar->start = start;
5115 bar->end = end;
5116
5117 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5118 if (end > top_range)
5119 end = top_range;
5120
5121 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5122 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5123 that many pixels tall. */
5124 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5125
5126 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5127 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5128 if (0 < start)
5129 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5130 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5131 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5132 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5133 inside_width, start,
5134 False);
5135
5136 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5137 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5138 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5139 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5140
5141 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5142 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5143 /* x, y, width, height */
5144 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5145 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5146 inside_width, end - start);
5147
5148 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5149 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5150 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5151 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5152
5153 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5154 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5155 if (end < inside_height)
5156 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5157 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5158 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5159 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5160 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5161 False);
5162
5163 }
5164
5165 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5166 }
5167
5168 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5169
5170 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5171 nil. */
5172
5173 static void
5174 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5175 {
5176 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5177 BLOCK_INPUT;
5178
5179 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5180 #ifdef USE_GTK
5181 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5182 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5183 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5184 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5185 #else
5186 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5187 #endif
5188
5189 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5190 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5191
5192 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5193 }
5194
5195
5196 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5197 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5198 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5199 create one. */
5200
5201 static void
5202 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5203 {
5204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5205 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5206 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5207 int window_y, window_height;
5208 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5209 int fringe_extended_p;
5210 #endif
5211
5212 /* Get window dimensions. */
5213 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5214 top = window_y;
5215 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5216 height = window_height;
5217
5218 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5219 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5220
5221 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5222 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5223 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5224 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5225 else
5226 sb_width = width;
5227
5228 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5229 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5230 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5231 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5232 else
5233 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5234 #else
5235 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5236 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5237 else
5238 sb_left = left;
5239 #endif
5240
5241 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5242 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5243 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5244 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5245 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5246 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5247 else
5248 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5249 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5250 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5251 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5252 #endif
5253
5254 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5255 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5256 {
5257 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5258 {
5259 BLOCK_INPUT;
5260 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5261 if (fringe_extended_p)
5262 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5263 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5264 else
5265 #endif
5266 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5267 left, top, width, height, False);
5268 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5269 }
5270
5271 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5272 }
5273 else
5274 {
5275 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5276 unsigned int mask = 0;
5277
5278 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5279
5280 BLOCK_INPUT;
5281
5282 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5283 mask |= CWX;
5284 if (top != bar->top)
5285 mask |= CWY;
5286 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5287 mask |= CWWidth;
5288 if (height != bar->height)
5289 mask |= CWHeight;
5290
5291 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5292
5293 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5294 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5295 {
5296 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5297 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5298 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5299 {
5300 if (fringe_extended_p)
5301 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5302 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5303 else
5304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5305 left, top, width, height, False);
5306 }
5307 #ifdef USE_GTK
5308 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5309 bar->x_window,
5310 top,
5311 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5312 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5313 max (height, 1));
5314 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5315 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5316 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5317 top,
5318 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5319 max (height, 1), 0);
5320 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5321 }
5322 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5323
5324 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5325 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5326 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5327 {
5328 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5329 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5330 height, False);
5331 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5332 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5333 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5334 height, False);
5335 }
5336
5337 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5338 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5339 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5340 example. */
5341 {
5342 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5343 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5344 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5345 {
5346 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5347 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5348 left + area_width - rest, top,
5349 rest, height, False);
5350 else
5351 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5352 left, top, rest, height, False);
5353 }
5354 }
5355
5356 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5357 if (mask)
5358 {
5359 XWindowChanges wc;
5360
5361 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5362 wc.y = top;
5363 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5364 wc.height = height;
5365 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5366 mask, &wc);
5367 }
5368
5369 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5370
5371 /* Remember new settings. */
5372 bar->left = sb_left;
5373 bar->top = top;
5374 bar->width = sb_width;
5375 bar->height = height;
5376
5377 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5378 }
5379
5380 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5381 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5382
5383 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5384 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5385 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5386 dragged. */
5387 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5388 {
5389 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5390
5391 if (whole == 0)
5392 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5393 else
5394 {
5395 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5396 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5397 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5398 }
5399 }
5400 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5401
5402 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5403 }
5404
5405
5406 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5407 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5408 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5409 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5410 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5411 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5412 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5413
5414 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5415 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5416 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5417
5418 static void
5419 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5420 {
5421 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5422 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5423 {
5424 Lisp_Object bar;
5425 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5426 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5427 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5428 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5429 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5430 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5431 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5432 }
5433 }
5434
5435
5436 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5437 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5438
5439 static void
5440 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5441 {
5442 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5443 struct frame *f;
5444
5445 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5446 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5447 abort ();
5448
5449 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5450
5451 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5452 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5453 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5454 {
5455 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5456 the lists. */
5457 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5458 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5459 return;
5460 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5461 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5462 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5463 else
5464 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5465 one or the other! */
5466 abort ();
5467 }
5468 else
5469 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5470
5471 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5472 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5473
5474 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5475 bar->prev = Qnil;
5476 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5477 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5478 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5479 }
5480
5481 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5482 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5483
5484 static void
5485 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5486 {
5487 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5488
5489 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5490
5491 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5492 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5493 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5494
5495 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5496 {
5497 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5498
5499 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5500
5501 next = b->next;
5502 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5503 }
5504
5505 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5506 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5507 }
5508
5509
5510 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5511 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5512 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5513
5514 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5515 mark bits. */
5516
5517 static void
5518 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5519 {
5520 Window w = bar->x_window;
5521 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5522 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5523 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5524
5525 BLOCK_INPUT;
5526
5527 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5528
5529 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5530 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5531 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5532 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5533
5534 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5535 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5536
5537 /* x, y, width, height */
5538 0, 0,
5539 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5540 bar->height - 1);
5541
5542 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5543 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5544 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5545 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5546
5547 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5548
5549 }
5550 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5551
5552 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5553 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5554
5555 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5556 mark bits. */
5557
5558
5559 static void
5560 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5561 {
5562 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5563 abort ();
5564
5565 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5566 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5567 emacs_event->modifiers
5568 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5569 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5570 event->xbutton.state)
5571 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5572 ? up_modifier
5573 : down_modifier));
5574 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5575 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5576 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5577 {
5578 int top_range
5579 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5580 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5581
5582 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5583 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5584
5585 if (y < bar->start)
5586 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5587 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5588 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5589 else
5590 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5591
5592 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5593 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5594 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5595 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5596 {
5597 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5598 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5599
5600 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5601 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5602 }
5603 #endif
5604
5605 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5606 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5607 }
5608 }
5609
5610 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5611
5612 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5613
5614 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5615 mark bits. */
5616
5617 static void
5618 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5619 {
5620 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5621
5622 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5623
5624 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5625 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5626
5627 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5628 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5629 {
5630 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5631 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5632
5633 if (new_start != bar->start)
5634 {
5635 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5636
5637 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5638 }
5639 }
5640 }
5641
5642 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5643
5644 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5645 on the scroll bar. */
5646
5647 static void
5648 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5649 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5650 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5651 {
5652 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5653 Window w = bar->x_window;
5654 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5655 int win_x, win_y;
5656 Window dummy_window;
5657 int dummy_coord;
5658 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5659
5660 BLOCK_INPUT;
5661
5662 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5663 report that. */
5664 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5665
5666 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5667 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5668 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5669
5670 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5671 &win_x, &win_y,
5672
5673 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5674 &dummy_mask))
5675 ;
5676 else
5677 {
5678 int top_range
5679 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5680
5681 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5682
5683 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5684 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5685
5686 if (win_y < 0)
5687 win_y = 0;
5688 if (win_y > top_range)
5689 win_y = top_range;
5690
5691 *fp = f;
5692 *bar_window = bar->window;
5693
5694 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5695 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5696 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5697 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5698 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5699 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5700 else
5701 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5702
5703 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5704 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5705
5706 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5707 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5708 }
5709
5710 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5711
5712 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5713 }
5714
5715
5716 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5717 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5718 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5719 redraw them. */
5720
5721 static void
5722 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5723 {
5724 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5725 Lisp_Object bar;
5726
5727 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5728 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5729 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5730 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5731 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5732 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5733 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5734 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5735 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5736 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5737 }
5738
5739 \f
5740 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5741
5742 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5743 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5744 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5745 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5746
5747 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5748 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5749
5750 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5751
5752 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5753 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5754
5755 static int temp_index;
5756 static short temp_buffer[100];
5757
5758 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5759 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5760 temp_index = 0; \
5761 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5762
5763 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5764 on a particular display. */
5765
5766 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5767
5768 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5769 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5770 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5771 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5772
5773 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5774
5775 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5776 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5777 do \
5778 { \
5779 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5780 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5781 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5782 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5783 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5784 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5785 } \
5786 while (0)
5787 #endif
5788
5789 enum
5790 {
5791 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5792 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5793 X_EVENT_DROP
5794 };
5795
5796 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5797 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5798 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5799
5800 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5801 this event further.
5802 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5803
5804 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5805 static int
5806 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5807 {
5808 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5809 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5810 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5811 was created. */
5812
5813 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5814 event->xclient.window);
5815
5816 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5817 }
5818 #endif
5819
5820 #ifdef USE_GTK
5821 static int current_count;
5822 static int current_finish;
5823 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5824
5825 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5826 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5827 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5828 static GdkFilterReturn
5829 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5830 {
5831 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5832
5833 BLOCK_INPUT;
5834 if (current_count >= 0)
5835 {
5836 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5837
5838 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5839
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5841 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5842 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5843 so we do it here. */
5844 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5845 && dpyinfo
5846 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5847 {
5848 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5849 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5850 }
5851 #endif
5852
5853 if (! dpyinfo)
5854 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5855 else
5856 current_count +=
5857 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5858 current_hold_quit);
5859 }
5860 else
5861 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5862
5863 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5864
5865 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5866 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5867
5868 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5869 }
5870 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5871
5872
5873 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5874 enum xembed_message,
5875 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5876
5877 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5878
5879 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5880 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5881 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5882
5883 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5884
5885 static int
5886 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5887 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5888 {
5889 union {
5890 struct input_event ie;
5891 struct selection_input_event sie;
5892 } inev;
5893 int count = 0;
5894 int do_help = 0;
5895 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5896 struct frame *f = NULL;
5897 struct coding_system coding;
5898 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5899 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5900 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5901
5902 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5903
5904 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5905 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5906 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5907
5908 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5909 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5910
5911 switch (event.type)
5912 {
5913 case ClientMessage:
5914 {
5915 if (event.xclient.message_type
5916 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5917 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5918 {
5919 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5920 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5921 {
5922 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5923 could be the shell widget window
5924 if the frame has no title bar. */
5925 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5926 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5927 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5928 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5929 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5930 #endif
5931 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5932 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5933 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5934 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5935 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5936 needed.
5937
5938 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5939 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5940 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5941 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5942 Emacs. */
5943
5944 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5945 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5946 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5947 if (f)
5948 {
5949 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5950 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5951 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5952 x_catch_errors (d);
5953 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5954 /* The ICCCM says this is
5955 the only valid choice. */
5956 RevertToParent,
5957 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5958 /* This is needed to detect the error
5959 if there is an error. */
5960 XSync (d, False);
5961 x_uncatch_errors ();
5962 }
5963 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5964 #endif /* 0 */
5965 goto done;
5966 }
5967
5968 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5969 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5970 {
5971 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5972 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5973 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5974 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5975 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5976 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5977 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5978 session manager and one for this. */
5979 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5980 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5981 #endif
5982 {
5983 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5984 event.xclient.window);
5985 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5986 for a single Emacs process. */
5987 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5988 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5989 event.xclient.window,
5990 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5991 else if (f)
5992 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5993 event.xclient.window,
5994 0, 0);
5995 }
5996 goto done;
5997 }
5998
5999 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
6000 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
6001 {
6002 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
6003 event.xclient.window);
6004 if (!f)
6005 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
6006
6007 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
6008 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6009 goto done;
6010 }
6011
6012 goto done;
6013 }
6014
6015 if (event.xclient.message_type
6016 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6017 {
6018 goto done;
6019 }
6020
6021 if (event.xclient.message_type
6022 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6023 {
6024 int new_x, new_y;
6025 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6026
6027 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6028 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6029
6030 if (f)
6031 {
6032 f->left_pos = new_x;
6033 f->top_pos = new_y;
6034 }
6035 goto done;
6036 }
6037
6038 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6039 if (event.xclient.message_type
6040 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6041 {
6042 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6043 if (f)
6044 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6045 &event, NULL);
6046 goto done;
6047 }
6048 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6049
6050 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6051 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6052 || (event.xclient.message_type
6053 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6054 {
6055 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6056 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6057 currently never do because we are interested in
6058 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6059 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6060 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6061 if (!f)
6062 goto OTHER;
6063 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6064 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6065 goto done;
6066 }
6067
6068 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6069 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6070 we construct an input_event. */
6071 if (event.xclient.message_type
6072 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6073 {
6074 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6075 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6076 goto done;
6077 }
6078 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6079
6080 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6081 if (event.xclient.message_type
6082 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6083 {
6084 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6085 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6086 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6087
6088 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6089 goto done;
6090 }
6091
6092 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6093
6094 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6095 if (!f)
6096 goto OTHER;
6097 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6098 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6099 }
6100 break;
6101
6102 case SelectionNotify:
6103 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6104 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6105 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6106 goto OTHER;
6107 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6108 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6109 break;
6110
6111 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6112 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6113 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6114 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6115 goto OTHER;
6116 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6117 {
6118 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6119
6120 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6121 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6122 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6123 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6124 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6125 }
6126 break;
6127
6128 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6129 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6130 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6131 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6132 goto OTHER;
6133 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6134 {
6135 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6136
6137 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6138 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6139 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6140 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6141 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6142 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6143 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6144 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6145 }
6146 break;
6147
6148 case PropertyNotify:
6149 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6150 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6151 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6152 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6153 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6154 {
6155 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6156 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6157 treat it as deiconified. */
6158 if (! f->async_iconified)
6159 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6160 f->async_visible = 1;
6161 f->async_iconified = 0;
6162 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6163 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6164 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6165 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6166 }
6167
6168 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6169 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6170 goto OTHER;
6171
6172 case ReparentNotify:
6173 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6174 if (f)
6175 {
6176 int x, y;
6177 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6178 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6179 f->left_pos = x;
6180 f->top_pos = y;
6181
6182 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6183 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6184 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6185
6186 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6187 }
6188 goto OTHER;
6189
6190 case Expose:
6191 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6192 if (f)
6193 {
6194 #ifdef USE_GTK
6195 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6196 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6197 event.xexpose.window,
6198 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6199 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6200 FALSE);
6201 #endif
6202 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6203 {
6204 f->async_visible = 1;
6205 f->async_iconified = 0;
6206 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6207 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6208 }
6209 else
6210 expose_frame (f,
6211 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6212 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6213 }
6214 else
6215 {
6216 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6217 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6218 #endif
6219 #if defined USE_LUCID
6220 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6221 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6222 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6223 {
6224 Widget widget
6225 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6226 if (widget)
6227 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6228 }
6229 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6230
6231 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6232 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6233 goto OTHER;
6234 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6235 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6236 event.xexpose.window);
6237
6238 if (bar)
6239 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6240 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6241 else
6242 goto OTHER;
6243 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6244 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6245 }
6246 break;
6247
6248 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6249 source area was obscured or not
6250 available. */
6251 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6252 if (f)
6253 {
6254 expose_frame (f,
6255 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6256 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6257 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6258 }
6259 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6260 else
6261 goto OTHER;
6262 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6263 break;
6264
6265 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6266 source area was completely
6267 available. */
6268 break;
6269
6270 case UnmapNotify:
6271 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6272 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6273 {
6274 tip_window = 0;
6275 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6276 }
6277
6278 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6279 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6280 the frame was deleted. */
6281 {
6282 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6283 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6284 display that won't ever be seen. */
6285 f->async_visible = 0;
6286 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6287 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6288 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6289 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6290 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6291 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6292 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6293 {
6294 f->async_iconified = 1;
6295
6296 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6297 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6298 }
6299 }
6300 goto OTHER;
6301
6302 case MapNotify:
6303 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6304 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6305 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6306 goto OTHER;
6307
6308 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6309 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6310 frame is visible. */
6311 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6312 if (f)
6313 {
6314 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6315 the frame's display structures.
6316 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6317 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6318 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6319 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6320 if (! f->async_iconified)
6321 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6322
6323 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6324 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6325 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6326 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6327
6328 f->async_visible = 1;
6329 f->async_iconified = 0;
6330 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6331
6332 if (f->iconified)
6333 {
6334 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6335 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6336 }
6337 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6338 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6339 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6340 to update the frame titles
6341 in case this is the second frame. */
6342 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6343
6344 #ifdef USE_GTK
6345 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6346 #endif
6347 }
6348 goto OTHER;
6349
6350 case KeyPress:
6351
6352 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6353 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6354
6355 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6356 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6357 if (popup_activated ())
6358 goto OTHER;
6359 #endif
6360
6361 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6362
6363 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6364 mouse highlighting. */
6365 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6366 && (f == 0
6367 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6368 {
6369 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6370 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6371 }
6372
6373 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6374 if (f == 0)
6375 {
6376 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6377 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6378 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6379 event.xkey.window);
6380 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6381 {
6382 widget = XtParent (widget);
6383 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6384 }
6385 }
6386 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6387
6388 if (f != 0)
6389 {
6390 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6391 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6392 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6393 his Emacs hang.
6394
6395 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6396 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6397 status_return even if the input is too long to
6398 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6399 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6400 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6401 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6402 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6403 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6404 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6405 int modifiers;
6406 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6407 Lisp_Object c;
6408
6409 #ifdef USE_GTK
6410 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6411 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6412 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6413 (see above). */
6414 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6415 #endif
6416
6417 event.xkey.state
6418 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6419 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6420 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6421
6422 /* This will have to go some day... */
6423
6424 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6425 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6426 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6427 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6428 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6429 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6430 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6431
6432 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6433 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6434 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6435 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6436 not it is combined with Meta. */
6437 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6438 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6439
6440 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6441 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6442 {
6443 Status status_return;
6444
6445 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6446 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6447 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6448 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6449 &status_return);
6450 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6451 {
6452 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6453 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6454 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6455 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6456 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6457 &status_return);
6458 }
6459 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6460 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6461 break;
6462 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6463 {
6464 keysym = NoSymbol;
6465 modifiers = 0;
6466 }
6467 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6468 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6469 abort ();
6470 }
6471 else
6472 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6473 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6474 &compose_status);
6475 #else
6476 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6477 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6478 &compose_status);
6479 #endif
6480
6481 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6482 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6483 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6484 break;
6485
6486 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6487 orig_keysym = keysym;
6488
6489 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6490 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6491 inev.ie.modifiers
6492 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6493 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6494
6495 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6496 translations to characters. */
6497 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6498 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6499 {
6500 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6501 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6502 goto done_keysym;
6503 }
6504
6505 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6506 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6507 {
6508 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6509 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6510 else
6511 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6512 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6513 goto done_keysym;
6514 }
6515
6516 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6517 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6518 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6519 Vx_keysym_table,
6520 Qnil),
6521 NATNUMP (c)))
6522 {
6523 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6524 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6525 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6526 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6527 goto done_keysym;
6528 }
6529
6530 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6531 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6532 || keysym == XK_Delete
6533 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6534 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6535 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6536 #endif
6537 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6538 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6539 #ifdef HPUX
6540 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6541 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6542 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6543 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6544 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6545 #endif
6546 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6547 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6548 #endif
6549 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6550 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6551 #endif
6552 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6553 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6554 #endif
6555 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6556 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6557 #endif
6558 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6559 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6560 #endif
6561 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6562 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6563 #endif
6564 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6565 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6566 #endif
6567 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6568 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6569 #endif
6570 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6571 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6572 #endif
6573 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6574 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6575 #endif
6576 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6577 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6578 #endif
6579 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6580 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6581 #endif
6582 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6583 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6584 #endif
6585 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6586 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6587 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6588 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6589 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6590 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6591 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6592 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6593 don't have real modifiers but
6594 should be treated similarly to
6595 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6596 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6597 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6598 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6599 #endif
6600 ))
6601 {
6602 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6603 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6604 key. */
6605 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6606 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6607 goto done_keysym;
6608 }
6609
6610 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6611 ptrdiff_t i;
6612 int nchars, len;
6613
6614 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6615 {
6616 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6617 nchars++;
6618 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6619 }
6620
6621 if (nchars < nbytes)
6622 {
6623 /* Decode the input data. */
6624
6625 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6626 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6627 we used just above and the locale. */
6628 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6629 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6630 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6631 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6632 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6633 gives us composition information. */
6634 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6635
6636 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6637 nbytes);
6638 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6639 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6640 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6641 nbytes = coding.produced;
6642 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6643 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6644 }
6645
6646 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6647 character events. */
6648 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6649 {
6650 int ch;
6651 if (nchars == nbytes)
6652 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6653 else
6654 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6655 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6656 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6657 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6658 inev.ie.code = ch;
6659 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6660 }
6661
6662 count += nchars;
6663
6664 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6665
6666 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6667 break;
6668 }
6669 }
6670 done_keysym:
6671 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6672 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6673 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6674 client. */
6675 break;
6676 #else
6677 goto OTHER;
6678 #endif
6679
6680 case KeyRelease:
6681 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6682 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6683 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6684 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6685 client. */
6686 break;
6687 #else
6688 goto OTHER;
6689 #endif
6690
6691 case EnterNotify:
6692 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6693 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6694
6695 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6696
6697 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6698 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6699
6700 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6701 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6702 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6703 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6704 #ifdef USE_GTK
6705 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6706 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6707 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6708 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6709 #endif
6710 goto OTHER;
6711
6712 case FocusIn:
6713 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6714 goto OTHER;
6715
6716 case LeaveNotify:
6717 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6718 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6719
6720 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6721 if (f)
6722 {
6723 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6724 {
6725 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6726 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6727 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6728 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6729 }
6730
6731 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6732 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6733 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6734 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6735 if (any_help_event_p)
6736 do_help = -1;
6737 }
6738 #ifdef USE_GTK
6739 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6740 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6741 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6742 #endif
6743 goto OTHER;
6744
6745 case FocusOut:
6746 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6747 goto OTHER;
6748
6749 case MotionNotify:
6750 {
6751 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6752 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6753 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6754
6755 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6756 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6757 f = last_mouse_frame;
6758 else
6759 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6760
6761 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6762 {
6763 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6764 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6765 }
6766
6767 #ifdef USE_GTK
6768 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6769 f = 0;
6770 #endif
6771 if (f)
6772 {
6773
6774 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6775 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6776 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6777 {
6778 Lisp_Object window;
6779
6780 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6781 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6782 0, 0);
6783
6784 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6785 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6786 will be selected only when it is active. */
6787 if (WINDOWP (window)
6788 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6789 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6790 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6791 create event iff we don't leave the
6792 selected frame. */
6793 && (focus_follows_mouse
6794 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6795 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6796 {
6797 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6798 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6799 }
6800
6801 last_window=window;
6802 }
6803 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6804 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6805 }
6806 else
6807 {
6808 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6809 struct scroll_bar *bar
6810 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6811 event.xmotion.window);
6812
6813 if (bar)
6814 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6815 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6816
6817 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6818 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6819 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6820 }
6821
6822 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6823 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6824 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6825 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6826 do_help = 1;
6827 goto OTHER;
6828 }
6829
6830 case ConfigureNotify:
6831 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6832 #ifdef USE_GTK
6833 if (!f
6834 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6835 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6836 {
6837 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6838 event.xconfigure.height);
6839 f = 0;
6840 }
6841 #endif
6842 if (f)
6843 {
6844 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6845 #ifndef USE_GTK
6846 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6847 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6848
6849 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6850 is called by the code that handles resizing
6851 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6852
6853 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6854 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6855 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6856 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6857 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6858 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6859 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6860 {
6861 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6862 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6863 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6864 }
6865
6866 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6867 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6868 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6869 #endif
6870
6871 #ifdef USE_GTK
6872 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6873 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6874 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6875 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6876 #endif
6877 {
6878 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6879 }
6880
6881 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6882 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6883 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6884 #endif
6885
6886 }
6887 goto OTHER;
6888
6889 case ButtonRelease:
6890 case ButtonPress:
6891 {
6892 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6893 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6894 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6895
6896 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6897 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6898 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6899
6900 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6901 && last_mouse_frame
6902 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6903 f = last_mouse_frame;
6904 else
6905 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6906
6907 #ifdef USE_GTK
6908 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6909 f = 0;
6910 #endif
6911 if (f)
6912 {
6913 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6914 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6915 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6916 {
6917 Lisp_Object window;
6918 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6919 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6920
6921 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6922 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6923
6924 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6925 {
6926 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6927 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6928 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6929 event.xbutton.state));
6930 }
6931 }
6932
6933 if (!tool_bar_p)
6934 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6935 if (! popup_activated ())
6936 #endif
6937 {
6938 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6939 {
6940 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6941 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6942 {
6943 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6944 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6945 }
6946 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6947 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6948 }
6949 else
6950 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6951 }
6952 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6953 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6954 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6955 }
6956 else
6957 {
6958 struct scroll_bar *bar
6959 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6960 event.xbutton.window);
6961
6962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6963 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6964 scroll bars. */
6965 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6966 {
6967 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6968 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6969 }
6970 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6971 if (bar)
6972 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6973 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6974 }
6975
6976 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6977 {
6978 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6979 last_mouse_frame = f;
6980
6981 if (!tool_bar_p)
6982 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6983 }
6984 else
6985 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6986
6987 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6988 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6989 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6990 if (f != 0)
6991 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6992
6993 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6994 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6995 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6996 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6997 Instead, save it away
6998 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6999 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
7000 if (! popup_activated ()
7001 #ifdef USE_GTK
7002 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
7003 && event.xbutton.button < 3
7004 #endif
7005 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
7006 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
7007 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
7008 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
7009 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
7010 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
7011 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7012 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7013 {
7014 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7015 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7016 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7017 }
7018 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7019 {
7020 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7021 goto OTHER;
7022 }
7023 else
7024 goto OTHER;
7025 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7026 }
7027 break;
7028
7029 case CirculateNotify:
7030 goto OTHER;
7031
7032 case CirculateRequest:
7033 goto OTHER;
7034
7035 case VisibilityNotify:
7036 goto OTHER;
7037
7038 case MappingNotify:
7039 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7040 local cache. */
7041 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7042 {
7043 case MappingModifier:
7044 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7045 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7046 case MappingKeyboard:
7047 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7048 }
7049 goto OTHER;
7050
7051 case DestroyNotify:
7052 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7053 break;
7054
7055 default:
7056 OTHER:
7057 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7058 BLOCK_INPUT;
7059 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7060 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7061 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7062 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7063 break;
7064 }
7065
7066 done:
7067 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7068 {
7069 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7070 count++;
7071 }
7072
7073 if (do_help
7074 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7075 {
7076 Lisp_Object frame;
7077
7078 if (f)
7079 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7080 else
7081 frame = Qnil;
7082
7083 if (do_help > 0)
7084 {
7085 any_help_event_p = 1;
7086 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7087 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7088 }
7089 else
7090 {
7091 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7092 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7093 }
7094 count++;
7095 }
7096
7097 SAFE_FREE ();
7098 *eventptr = event;
7099 return count;
7100 }
7101
7102 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7103
7104 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7105 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7106 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7107
7108 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7109 int
7110 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7111 {
7112 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7113 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7114
7115 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7116
7117 if (dpyinfo)
7118 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7119
7120 return finish;
7121 }
7122 #endif
7123
7124
7125 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7126 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7127 not defined.
7128 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7129
7130 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7131 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7132 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7133 C chars).
7134
7135 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7136
7137 static int
7138 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7139 {
7140 int count = 0;
7141 int event_found = 0;
7142
7143 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7144 {
7145 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7146 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7147 pending_signals = 1;
7148 #endif
7149 return -1;
7150 }
7151
7152 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7153 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7154 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7155 #endif
7156 BLOCK_INPUT;
7157
7158 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7159 input_signal_count++;
7160
7161 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7162 ++handling_signal;
7163 #endif
7164
7165 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7166 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7167 {
7168 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7169 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7170 }
7171
7172 #ifndef USE_GTK
7173 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7174 {
7175 int finish;
7176 XEvent event;
7177
7178 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7179
7180 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7181 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7182 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7183 continue;
7184 #endif
7185 event_found = 1;
7186
7187 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7188 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7189
7190 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7191 goto out;
7192 }
7193
7194 out:;
7195
7196 #else /* USE_GTK */
7197
7198 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7199 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7200 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7201 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7202
7203 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7204 from all displays. */
7205
7206 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7207 {
7208 current_count = count;
7209 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7210
7211 gtk_main_iteration ();
7212
7213 count = current_count;
7214 current_count = -1;
7215 current_hold_quit = 0;
7216
7217 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7218 break;
7219 }
7220 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7221
7222 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7223 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7224 if (! event_found)
7225 {
7226 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7227 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7228 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7229 x_noop_count++;
7230 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7231 {
7232 x_noop_count=0;
7233
7234 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7235 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7236
7237 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7238
7239 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7240 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7241 }
7242 }
7243
7244 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7245 raise it now. */
7246 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7247 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7248 {
7249 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7250 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7251 }
7252
7253 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7254 --handling_signal;
7255 #endif
7256 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7257
7258 return count;
7259 }
7260
7261
7262
7263 \f
7264 /***********************************************************************
7265 Text Cursor
7266 ***********************************************************************/
7267
7268 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7269 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7270
7271 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7272 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7273 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7274
7275 static void
7276 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7277 {
7278 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7279 XRectangle clip_rect;
7280 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7281
7282 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7283
7284 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7285 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7286 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7287 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7288 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7289
7290 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7291 }
7292
7293
7294 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7295
7296 static void
7297 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7298 {
7299 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7300 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7301 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7302 int x, y, wd, h;
7303 XGCValues xgcv;
7304 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7305 GC gc;
7306
7307 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7308 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7309 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7310 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7311 return;
7312
7313 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7314 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7315 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7316
7317 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7318 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7319 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7320 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7321 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7322 else
7323 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7324 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7325 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7326
7327 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7328 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7329 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7330 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7331 }
7332
7333
7334 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7335
7336 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7337 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7338 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7339 --gerd. */
7340
7341 static void
7342 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7343 {
7344 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7345 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7346
7347 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7348 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7349 and mini-buffer. */
7350 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7351 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7352 return;
7353
7354 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7355 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7356 the bar might not be in the window. */
7357 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7358 {
7359 struct glyph_row *r;
7360 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7361 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7362 }
7363 else
7364 {
7365 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7366 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7367 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7368 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7369 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7370 XGCValues xgcv;
7371
7372 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7373 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7374 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7375 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7376 that the glyph is legible. */
7377 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7378 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7379 else
7380 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7381 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7382
7383 if (gc)
7384 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7385 else
7386 {
7387 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7388 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7389 }
7390
7391 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7392
7393 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7394 {
7395 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7396
7397 if (width < 0)
7398 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7399 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7400
7401 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7402
7403 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7404 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7405 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7406 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7407
7408 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7409 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7410 width, row->height);
7411 }
7412 else
7413 {
7414 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7415
7416 if (width < 0)
7417 width = row->height;
7418
7419 width = min (row->height, width);
7420
7421 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7422 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7423
7424 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7425 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7426 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7427 row->height - width),
7428 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7429 }
7430
7431 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7432 }
7433 }
7434
7435
7436 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7437
7438 static void
7439 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7440 {
7441 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7442 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7443 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7444 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7445 }
7446
7447
7448 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7449
7450 static void
7451 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7452 {
7453 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7454 x, y, width, height, False);
7455 #ifdef USE_GTK
7456 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7457 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7458 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7459 #endif
7460 }
7461
7462
7463 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7464
7465 static void
7466 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7467 {
7468 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7469
7470 if (on_p)
7471 {
7472 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7473 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7474
7475 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7476 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7477 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7478 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7479 {
7480 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7481 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7482 }
7483 else
7484 {
7485 switch (cursor_type)
7486 {
7487 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7488 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7489 break;
7490
7491 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7492 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7493 break;
7494
7495 case BAR_CURSOR:
7496 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7497 break;
7498
7499 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7500 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7501 break;
7502
7503 case NO_CURSOR:
7504 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7505 break;
7506
7507 default:
7508 abort ();
7509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7513 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7514 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7515 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7516 #endif
7517 }
7518
7519 #ifndef XFlush
7520 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7521 #endif
7522 }
7523
7524 \f
7525 /* Icons. */
7526
7527 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7528
7529 int
7530 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7531 {
7532 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7533
7534 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7535 return 1;
7536
7537 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7538 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7539 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7540 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7541
7542 if (STRINGP (file))
7543 {
7544 #ifdef USE_GTK
7545 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7546 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7547 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7548 return 0;
7549 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7550 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7551 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7552 }
7553 else
7554 {
7555 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7556 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7557 {
7558 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7559
7560 #ifdef USE_GTK
7561
7562 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7563 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7564 return 0;
7565
7566 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7567
7568 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7569 if (rc != -1)
7570 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7571
7572 #endif
7573
7574 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7575 if (rc == -1)
7576 {
7577 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7578 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7579 if (rc == -1)
7580 return 1;
7581
7582 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7583 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7584 }
7585 }
7586
7587 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7588 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7589 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7590 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7591 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7592
7593 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7594 }
7595
7596 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7597 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7598
7599 return 0;
7600 }
7601
7602
7603 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7604 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7605
7606 int
7607 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7608 {
7609 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7610 return 1;
7611
7612 {
7613 XTextProperty text;
7614 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7615 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7616 text.format = 8;
7617 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7618 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7619 }
7620
7621 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7622 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7623 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7624 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7625
7626 return 0;
7627 }
7628 \f
7629 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7630
7631 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7632 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7633
7634 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7635 be called from a signal handler.
7636 */
7637
7638 struct x_error_message_stack {
7639 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7640 Display *dpy;
7641 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7642 };
7643 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7644
7645 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7646 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7647 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7648
7649 static void
7650 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7651 {
7652 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7653 x_error_message->string,
7654 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7655 }
7656
7657 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7658 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7659 operating on.
7660
7661 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7662 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7663 stored in *x_error_message.
7664
7665 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7666 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7667
7668 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7669
7670 void
7671 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7672 {
7673 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7674
7675 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7676 XSync (dpy, False);
7677
7678 data->dpy = dpy;
7679 data->string[0] = 0;
7680 data->prev = x_error_message;
7681 x_error_message = data;
7682 }
7683
7684 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7685 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7686
7687 void
7688 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7689 {
7690 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7691
7692 BLOCK_INPUT;
7693
7694 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7695 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7696 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7697 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7698
7699 tmp = x_error_message;
7700 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7701 xfree (tmp);
7702 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7703 }
7704
7705 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7706 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7707 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7708
7709 void
7710 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7711 {
7712 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7713 XSync (dpy, False);
7714
7715 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7716 {
7717 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7718 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7719 x_uncatch_errors ();
7720 error (format, string);
7721 }
7722 }
7723
7724 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7725 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7726
7727 int
7728 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7729 {
7730 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7731 XSync (dpy, False);
7732
7733 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7734 }
7735
7736 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7737
7738 void
7739 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7740 {
7741 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7742 }
7743
7744 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7745 * idea. --lorentey */
7746 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7747
7748 void
7749 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7750 {
7751 while (x_error_message)
7752 x_uncatch_errors ();
7753 }
7754 #endif
7755
7756 #if 0
7757 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7758 x_trace_wire (void)
7759 {
7760 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7761 }
7762 #endif /* ! 0 */
7763
7764 \f
7765 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7766 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7767 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7768 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7769 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7770
7771 static void
7772 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7773 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7774 {
7775 #ifdef USG
7776 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7777 must reestablish each time */
7778 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7779 #endif /* USG */
7780 }
7781
7782 \f
7783 /************************************************************************
7784 Handling X errors
7785 ************************************************************************/
7786
7787 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7788
7789 static char *error_msg;
7790
7791 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7792 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7793
7794 static void
7795 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7796 {
7797 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7798 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7799 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7800
7801 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7802 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7803 handling_signal = 0;
7804
7805 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7806 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7807
7808 if (dpyinfo)
7809 {
7810 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7811 frame on it. */
7812 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7813 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7814 }
7815
7816 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7817 that are on the dead display. */
7818 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7819 {
7820 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7821 minibuf_frame
7822 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7823 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7824 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7825 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7826 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7827 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7828 }
7829
7830 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7831 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7832 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7833 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7834 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7835 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7836 {
7837 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7838 trying to find a replacement. */
7839 KVAR (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Vdefault_minibuffer_frame) = Qt;
7840 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7841 }
7842
7843 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7844 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7845 if (dpyinfo)
7846 {
7847 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7848 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7849 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7850 #ifdef USE_GTK
7851 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7852 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7853 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7854 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7855 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7856 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7857 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7858 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7859 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7860 error_msg);
7861 abort ();
7862 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7863
7864 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7865 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7866
7867 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7868 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7869 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7870 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7871 abort ();
7872
7873 {
7874 Lisp_Object tmp;
7875 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7876 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7877 }
7878 }
7879
7880 if (terminal_list == 0)
7881 {
7882 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7883 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7884 /* NOTREACHED */
7885 }
7886
7887 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7888 #ifdef SIGIO
7889 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7890 #endif
7891 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7892 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7893
7894 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7895 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7896
7897 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7898 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7899
7900 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7901 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7902 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7903 error ("%s", error_msg);
7904 }
7905
7906 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7907 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7908 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7909
7910 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7911 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7912
7913 static int
7914 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7915 {
7916 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7917 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7918 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7919 && event->minor_code == 0)
7920 {
7921 return 0;
7922 }
7923 #endif
7924
7925 if (x_error_message)
7926 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7927 else
7928 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7929 return 0;
7930 }
7931
7932 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7933 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7934 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7935
7936 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7937
7938 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7939 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7940
7941 static void NO_INLINE
7942 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7943 {
7944 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7945
7946 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7947 or colors that are not defined. */
7948
7949 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7950 return;
7951
7952 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7953 original error handler. */
7954
7955 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7956 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7957 buf, event->request_code);
7958 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7959 }
7960
7961
7962 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7963 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7964 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7965
7966 static int
7967 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7968 {
7969 char buf[256];
7970
7971 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7972 DisplayString (display));
7973 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7974 return 0;
7975 }
7976 \f
7977 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7978
7979 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7980 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7981 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7982 FONT-OBJECT. */
7983
7984 Lisp_Object
7985 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7986 {
7987 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7988
7989 if (fontset < 0)
7990 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7991 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7992 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7993 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7994 do. */
7995 return font_object;
7996
7997 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7998 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7999 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
8000 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
8001 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8002
8003 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8004
8005 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8006 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8007 {
8008 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8009 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8010 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8011 }
8012 else
8013 {
8014 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8015 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8016 }
8017
8018 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8019 {
8020 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8021 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8022 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8023 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8024 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8025 }
8026
8027 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8028 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8029 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8030 {
8031 BLOCK_INPUT;
8032 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8033 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8034 }
8035 #endif
8036
8037 return font_object;
8038 }
8039
8040 \f
8041 /***********************************************************************
8042 X Input Methods
8043 ***********************************************************************/
8044
8045 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8046
8047 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8048
8049 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8050 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8051 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8052
8053 static void
8054 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8055 {
8056 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8057 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8058
8059 BLOCK_INPUT;
8060
8061 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8062 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8063 {
8064 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8065 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8066 {
8067 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8068 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8069 }
8070 }
8071
8072 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8073 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8074 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8075 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8076 }
8077
8078 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8079
8080 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8081 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8082 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8083 #endif
8084
8085 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8086 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8087
8088 static void
8089 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8090 {
8091 XIM xim;
8092
8093 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8094 if (use_xim)
8095 {
8096 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8097 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8098 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8099 emacs_class);
8100 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8101
8102 if (xim)
8103 {
8104 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8105 XIMCallback destroy;
8106 #endif
8107
8108 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8109 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8110
8111 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8112 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8113 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8114 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8115 #endif
8116 }
8117 }
8118
8119 else
8120 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8121 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8122 }
8123
8124
8125 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8126
8127 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8128 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8129 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8130 when the callback was registered. */
8131
8132 static void
8133 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8134 {
8135 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8136 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8137
8138 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8139 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8140 return;
8141
8142 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8143
8144 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8145 as they have no XIC. */
8146 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8147 {
8148 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8149
8150 BLOCK_INPUT;
8151 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8152 {
8153 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8154
8155 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8156 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8157 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8158 {
8159 create_frame_xic (f);
8160 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8161 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8162 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8163 {
8164 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8165 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8166 }
8167 }
8168 }
8169
8170 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8171 }
8172 }
8173
8174 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8175
8176
8177 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8178 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8179 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8180 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8181
8182 static void
8183 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8184 {
8185 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8186 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8187 if (use_xim)
8188 {
8189 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8190 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8191 ptrdiff_t len;
8192
8193 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8194 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8195 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8196 len = strlen (resource_name);
8197 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8198 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8199 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8200 resource_name, emacs_class,
8201 xim_instantiate_callback,
8202 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8203 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8204 least, hence the configure test. */
8205 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8206 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8207 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8208 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8209 }
8210 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8211 }
8212
8213
8214 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8215
8216 static void
8217 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8218 {
8219 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8220 if (use_xim)
8221 {
8222 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8223 if (dpyinfo->display)
8224 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8225 NULL, emacs_class,
8226 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8227 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8228 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8229 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8230 if (dpyinfo->display)
8231 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8232 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8233 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8234 }
8235 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8236 }
8237
8238 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8239
8240
8241 \f
8242 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8243 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8244
8245 static void
8246 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8247 {
8248 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8249
8250 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8251 is already for the top-left corner. */
8252 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8253 return;
8254
8255 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8256 position that fits on the screen. */
8257 if (flags & XNegative)
8258 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8259 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8260
8261 {
8262 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8263
8264 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8265 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8266 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8267
8268 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8269 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8270 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8271 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8272 is right, though.
8273
8274 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8275 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8276
8277 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8278 #endif
8279
8280 if (flags & YNegative)
8281 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8282 - height + f->top_pos;
8283 }
8284
8285 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8286 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8287 so the flags should correspond. */
8288 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8289 }
8290
8291 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8292 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8293 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8294 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8295 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8296
8297 void
8298 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8299 {
8300 int modified_top, modified_left;
8301
8302 if (change_gravity > 0)
8303 {
8304 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8305 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8306
8307 f->top_pos = yoff;
8308 f->left_pos = xoff;
8309 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8310 if (xoff < 0)
8311 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8312 if (yoff < 0)
8313 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8314 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8315 }
8316 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8317
8318 BLOCK_INPUT;
8319 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8320
8321 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8322 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8323
8324 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8325 {
8326 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8327 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8328 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8329 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8330 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8331 }
8332
8333 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8334 modified_left, modified_top);
8335
8336 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8337 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8338 ? 1 : 0);
8339
8340 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8341 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8342 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8343 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8344 of the frame.
8345
8346 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8347 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8348 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8349
8350 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8351 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8352 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8353 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8354 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8355 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8356
8357 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8358 }
8359
8360 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8361 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8362 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8363 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8364 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8365
8366 static int
8367 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8368 {
8369 Atom actual_type;
8370 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8371 int i, rc, actual_format;
8372 Window wmcheck_window;
8373 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8374 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8375 long max_len = 65536;
8376 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8377 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8378 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8379
8380 BLOCK_INPUT;
8381
8382 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8383 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8384 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8385 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8386 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8387 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8388
8389 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8390 {
8391 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8392 x_uncatch_errors ();
8393 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8394 return 0;
8395 }
8396
8397 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8398 XFree (tmp_data);
8399
8400 /* Check if window exists. */
8401 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8402 x_sync (f);
8403 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8404 {
8405 x_uncatch_errors ();
8406 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8407 return 0;
8408 }
8409
8410 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8411 {
8412 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8413 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8414 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8415 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8416 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8417 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8418
8419 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8420 tmp_data = NULL;
8421 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8422 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8423 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8424 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8425 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8426
8427 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8428 {
8429 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8430 x_uncatch_errors ();
8431 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8432 return 0;
8433 }
8434
8435 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8436 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8437 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8438 }
8439
8440 rc = 0;
8441
8442 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8443 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8444
8445 x_uncatch_errors ();
8446 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8447
8448 return rc;
8449 }
8450
8451 static void
8452 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8453 {
8454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8455
8456 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8457 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8458 make_number (32),
8459 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8460 Fcons
8461 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8462 Fcons
8463 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8464 value != 0
8465 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8466 : Qnil)));
8467 }
8468
8469 void
8470 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8471 {
8472 Lisp_Object frame;
8473 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8474
8475 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8476
8477 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8478 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8479 }
8480
8481 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8482 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8483 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8484
8485 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8486
8487 static int
8488 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8489 Window window,
8490 int *size_state,
8491 int *sticky)
8492 {
8493 Atom actual_type;
8494 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8495 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8496 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8497 long max_len = 65536;
8498 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8499 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8500 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8501
8502 *sticky = 0;
8503 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8504
8505 BLOCK_INPUT;
8506 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8507 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8508 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8509 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8510 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8511
8512 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8513 {
8514 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8515 x_uncatch_errors ();
8516 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8517 return ! f->iconified;
8518 }
8519
8520 x_uncatch_errors ();
8521
8522 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8523 {
8524 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8525 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8526 {
8527 is_hidden = 1;
8528 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8529 }
8530 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8531 {
8532 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8533 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8534 else
8535 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8536 }
8537 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8538 {
8539 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8540 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8541 else
8542 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8543 }
8544 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8545 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8546 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8547 *sticky = 1;
8548 }
8549
8550 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8551 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8552 return ! is_hidden;
8553 }
8554
8555 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8556
8557 static int
8558 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8559 {
8560 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8561 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8562 int cur, dummy;
8563
8564 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8565
8566 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8567 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8568 if (!have_net_atom)
8569 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8570
8571 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8572 {
8573 Lisp_Object frame;
8574
8575 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8576
8577 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8578 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8579 are sent at once. */
8580 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8581 {
8582 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8583 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8584 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8585 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8586 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8587 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8588 break;
8589 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8590 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8591 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8592 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8593 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8594 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8595 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8596 break;
8597 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8598 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8599 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8600 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8601 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8602 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8603 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8604 break;
8605 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8606 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8607 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8608 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8609 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8610 break;
8611 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8612 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8613 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8614 else
8615 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8616 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8617 }
8618
8619 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8620
8621 }
8622
8623 return have_net_atom;
8624 }
8625
8626 static void
8627 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8628 {
8629 if (f->async_visible)
8630 {
8631 BLOCK_INPUT;
8632 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8633 x_sync (f);
8634 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8635 }
8636 }
8637
8638
8639 static int
8640 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8641 {
8642 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8643 Lisp_Object lval;
8644 int sticky = 0;
8645 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8646
8647 lval = Qnil;
8648 switch (value)
8649 {
8650 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8651 lval = Qfullwidth;
8652 break;
8653 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8654 lval = Qfullheight;
8655 break;
8656 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8657 lval = Qfullboth;
8658 break;
8659 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8660 lval = Qmaximized;
8661 break;
8662 }
8663
8664 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8665 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8666
8667 return not_hidden;
8668 }
8669
8670 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8671 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8672 static void
8673 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8674 {
8675 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8676 return;
8677
8678 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8679 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8680
8681 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8682 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8683 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8684
8685 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8686 {
8687 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8688 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8689
8690 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8691 {
8692 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8693 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8694 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8695 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8696 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8697 break;
8698 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8699 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8700 break;
8701 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8702 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8703 }
8704
8705 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8706 width, height);
8707 }
8708 }
8709
8710 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8711 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8712 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8713 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8714 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8715 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8716 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8717
8718 static void
8719 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8720 {
8721 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8722
8723 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8724 window manager window around the frame. */
8725
8726 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8727
8728 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8729 {
8730 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8731
8732 int adjusted_left;
8733 int adjusted_top;
8734
8735 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8736 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8737 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8738
8739 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8740
8741 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8742 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8743
8744 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8745 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8746
8747 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8748 }
8749 else
8750 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8751 frame's position. */
8752
8753 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8754 }
8755
8756
8757 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8758 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8759 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8760 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8761 of an exact comparison. */
8762
8763 static void
8764 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8765 {
8766 int count = 0;
8767
8768 while (count++ < 50)
8769 {
8770 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8771
8772 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8773 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8774 loop. */
8775
8776 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8777 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8778
8779 if (fuzzy)
8780 {
8781 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8782 pixels. */
8783
8784 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8785 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8786 return;
8787 }
8788 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8789 return;
8790 }
8791
8792 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8793 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8794
8795 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8796 }
8797
8798
8799 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8800 void
8801 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8802 {
8803 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8804
8805 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8806 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8807 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8808
8809 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8810 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8811
8812 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8813 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8814 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8815 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8816 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8817
8818 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8819 {
8820 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8821 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8822 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8823 BLOCK_INPUT;
8824 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8825
8826 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8827 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8828
8829 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8830 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8831 break;
8832
8833 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8834 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8835 break; /* Timeout */
8836 }
8837 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8838 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8839 }
8840
8841
8842 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8843 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8844 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8845 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8846
8847 static void
8848 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8849 {
8850 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8851
8852 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8853 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8854 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8855 ? 0
8856 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8857
8858 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8859
8860 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8861 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8862 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8863 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8864
8865 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8866 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8867 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8868 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8869
8870
8871 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8872 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8873 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8874 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8875 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8876
8877 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8878 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8879 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8880 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8881
8882 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8883 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8884 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8885 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8886 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8887
8888 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8889 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8890
8891 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8892 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8893 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8894 if (f->async_visible)
8895 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8896 else
8897 {
8898 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8899 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8900 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8901 x_sync (f);
8902 }
8903 }
8904
8905
8906 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8907 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8908 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8909 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8910
8911 void
8912 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8913 {
8914 BLOCK_INPUT;
8915
8916 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8917 {
8918 int r, c;
8919
8920 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8921 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8922 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8923 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8924 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8925 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8926 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8927 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8928 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8929 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8930 is however. */
8931 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8932 #endif
8933 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8934 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8935 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8936 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8937 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8938 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8939 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8940 }
8941
8942 #ifdef USE_GTK
8943 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8944 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8945 else
8946 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8947 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8948
8949 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8950
8951 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8952
8953 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8954 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8955
8956 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8957 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8958 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8959 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8960 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8961
8962 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8963 }
8964 \f
8965 /* Mouse warping. */
8966
8967 void
8968 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8969 {
8970 int pix_x, pix_y;
8971
8972 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8973 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8974
8975 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8976 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8977
8978 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8979 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8980
8981 BLOCK_INPUT;
8982
8983 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8984 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8985 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8986 }
8987
8988 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8989
8990 void
8991 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8992 {
8993 BLOCK_INPUT;
8994
8995 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8996 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8997 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8998 }
8999 \f
9000 /* Raise frame F. */
9001
9002 void
9003 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
9004 {
9005 BLOCK_INPUT;
9006 if (f->async_visible)
9007 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9008
9009 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9010 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9011 }
9012
9013 /* Lower frame F. */
9014
9015 static void
9016 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9017 {
9018 if (f->async_visible)
9019 {
9020 BLOCK_INPUT;
9021 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9022 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9023 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9024 }
9025 }
9026
9027 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9028
9029 void
9030 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9031 {
9032 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9033 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9034 if (f->async_visible)
9035 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9036 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9037 }
9038
9039 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9040
9041 void
9042 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9043 {
9044 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9045 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9046
9047 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9048 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9049 {
9050 Lisp_Object frame;
9051 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9052 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9053 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9054 make_number (32),
9055 Fcons (make_number (1),
9056 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9057 Qnil)));
9058 }
9059 }
9060
9061 static void
9062 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9063 {
9064 if (raise_flag)
9065 x_raise_frame (f);
9066 else
9067 x_lower_frame (f);
9068 }
9069 \f
9070 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9071
9072 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9073
9074 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9075
9076 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9077
9078 static void
9079 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9080 {
9081 unsigned long data[2];
9082 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9083
9084 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9085 data[1] = flags;
9086
9087 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9088 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9089 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9090 }
9091 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9092
9093 static void
9094 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9095 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9096 {
9097 XEvent event;
9098
9099 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9100 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9101 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9102 event.xclient.format = 32;
9103 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9104 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9105 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9106 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9107 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9108
9109 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9110 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9111 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9112 }
9113 \f
9114 /* Change of visibility. */
9115
9116 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9117 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9118 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9119 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9120 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9121 finishes with it. */
9122
9123 void
9124 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9125 {
9126 Lisp_Object type;
9127 int original_top, original_left;
9128 int retry_count = 2;
9129
9130 retry:
9131
9132 BLOCK_INPUT;
9133
9134 type = x_icon_type (f);
9135 if (!NILP (type))
9136 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9137
9138 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9139 {
9140 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9141 call x_set_offset a second time
9142 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9143 before the window gets really visible. */
9144 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9145 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9146 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9147 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9148
9149 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9150
9151 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9152 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9154 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9155 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9156 else
9157 {
9158 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9159 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9160 }
9161 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9162 #ifdef USE_GTK
9163 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9164 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9165 #else
9166 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9167 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9168 else
9169 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9170 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9171 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9172 }
9173
9174 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9175
9176 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9177 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9178 so that incoming events are handled. */
9179 {
9180 Lisp_Object frame;
9181 int count;
9182 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9183 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9184 will set it when they are handled. */
9185 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9186
9187 original_left = f->left_pos;
9188 original_top = f->top_pos;
9189
9190 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9191 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9192
9193 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9194
9195 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9196 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9197 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9198 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9199
9200 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9201 because the window manager may choose the position
9202 and we don't want to override it. */
9203
9204 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9205 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9206 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9207 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9208 && previously_visible)
9209 {
9210 Drawable rootw;
9211 int x, y;
9212 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9213
9214 BLOCK_INPUT;
9215
9216 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9217 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9218 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9219 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9220 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9221 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9222 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9223 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9224 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9225
9226 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9227 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9228 original_left, original_top);
9229
9230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9231 }
9232
9233 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9234
9235 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9236 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9237 MapNotify at all.. */
9238 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9239 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9240 {
9241 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9242 x_sync (f);
9243
9244 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9245 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9246 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9247 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9248 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9249 probably a bug. */
9250 if (input_polling_used ())
9251 {
9252 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9253 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9254 handler reset it. */
9255 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9256 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9257 poll_for_input_1 ();
9258 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9259 }
9260
9261 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9262 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9263 }
9264
9265 /* 2000-09-28: In
9266
9267 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9268 (iconify-frame f)
9269 (raise-frame f))
9270
9271 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9272 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9273 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9274 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9275
9276 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9277 goto retry;
9278 }
9279 }
9280
9281 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9282
9283 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9284
9285 void
9286 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9287 {
9288 Window window;
9289
9290 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9291 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9292
9293 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9294 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9295 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9296
9297 BLOCK_INPUT;
9298
9299 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9300 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9301 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9302 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9303 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9304 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9305
9306 #ifdef USE_GTK
9307 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9308 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9309 else
9310 #else
9311 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9312 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9313 else
9314 #endif
9315 {
9316
9317 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9318 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9319 {
9320 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9321 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9322 }
9323 }
9324
9325 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9326 just by the event that we get from the server.
9327 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9328 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9329 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9330 f->visible = 0;
9331 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9332 f->async_visible = 0;
9333 f->async_iconified = 0;
9334
9335 x_sync (f);
9336
9337 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9338 }
9339
9340 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9341
9342 void
9343 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9344 {
9345 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9346 int result;
9347 #endif
9348 Lisp_Object type;
9349
9350 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9351 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9352 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9353
9354 if (f->async_iconified)
9355 return;
9356
9357 BLOCK_INPUT;
9358
9359 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9360
9361 type = x_icon_type (f);
9362 if (!NILP (type))
9363 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9364
9365 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9366 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9367 {
9368 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9369 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9370
9371 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9372 f->iconified = 1;
9373 f->visible = 1;
9374 f->async_iconified = 1;
9375 f->async_visible = 0;
9376 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9377 return;
9378 }
9379 #endif
9380
9381 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9382
9383 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9384 {
9385 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9386 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9387 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9388 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9389 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9390 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9391 so we have to record it here. */
9392 f->iconified = 1;
9393 f->visible = 1;
9394 f->async_iconified = 1;
9395 f->async_visible = 0;
9396 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9397 return;
9398 }
9399
9400 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9401 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9402 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9404
9405 if (!result)
9406 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9407
9408 f->async_iconified = 1;
9409 f->async_visible = 0;
9410
9411
9412 BLOCK_INPUT;
9413 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9414 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9415 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9416
9417 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9418 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9419 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9420 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9421 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9422 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9423
9424 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9425 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9426
9427 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9428 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9429 {
9430 XEvent msg;
9431
9432 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9433 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9434 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9435 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9436 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9437
9438 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9439 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9440 False,
9441 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9442 &msg))
9443 {
9444 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9445 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9446 }
9447 }
9448
9449 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9450 IconicState. */
9451 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9452
9453 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9454 {
9455 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9456 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9457 }
9458
9459 f->async_iconified = 1;
9460 f->async_visible = 0;
9461
9462 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9463 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9464 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9465 }
9466
9467 \f
9468 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9469
9470 void
9471 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9472 {
9473 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9474 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9475 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9476 Lisp_Object bar;
9477 struct scroll_bar *b;
9478 #endif
9479
9480 BLOCK_INPUT;
9481
9482 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9483 commands to the X server. */
9484 if (dpyinfo->display)
9485 {
9486 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9487 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9488 face. */
9489 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9490 free_frame_faces (f);
9491
9492 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9493 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9494
9495 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9496 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9497 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9498 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9499 toolkit scroll bars. */
9500 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9501 {
9502 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9503 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9504 }
9505 #endif
9506
9507 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9508 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9509 free_frame_xic (f);
9510 #endif
9511
9512 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9513 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9514 {
9515 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9516 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9517 }
9518 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9519 we are using a toolkit. */
9520 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9521 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9522
9523 free_frame_menubar (f);
9524 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9525
9526 #ifdef USE_GTK
9527 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9528 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9529
9530 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9531 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9532 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9533
9534 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9535 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9536 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9537 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9538 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9539 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9540
9541 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9542 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9543 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9544 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9545 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9546 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9547 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9548 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9549 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9550 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9551 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9552 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9553 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9554 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9555 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9556
9557 x_free_gcs (f);
9558 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9559 }
9560
9561 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9562 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9563 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9564
9565 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9566 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9567 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9568 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9569 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9570 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9571
9572 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9573 {
9574 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9575 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9576 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9577 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9578 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9579 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9580 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9581 }
9582
9583 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9584 }
9585
9586
9587 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9588
9589 static void
9590 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9591 {
9592 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9593
9594 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9595 commands to the X server. */
9596 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9597 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9598
9599 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9600 }
9601
9602 \f
9603 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9604
9605 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9606 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9607 that the window now has.
9608 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9609 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9610 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9611
9612 #ifndef USE_GTK
9613 void
9614 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9615 {
9616 XSizeHints size_hints;
9617 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9618
9619 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9620 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9621 {
9622 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9623 return;
9624 }
9625 #endif
9626
9627 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9628 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9629
9630 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9631 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9632
9633 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9634 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9635
9636 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9637 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9638 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9639 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9640 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9641 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9642
9643 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9644 {
9645 int base_width, base_height;
9646 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9647
9648 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9649 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9650
9651 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9652
9653 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9654 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9655 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9656 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9657 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9658
9659 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9660 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9661 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9662
9663 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9664 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9665 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9666 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9667 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9668 }
9669
9670 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9671 if (flags)
9672 {
9673 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9674 goto no_read;
9675 }
9676
9677 {
9678 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9679 long supplied_return;
9680 int value;
9681
9682 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9683 &supplied_return);
9684
9685 if (flags)
9686 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9687 else
9688 {
9689 if (value == 0)
9690 hints.flags = 0;
9691 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9692 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9693 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9694 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9695 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9696 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9697 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9698 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9699 }
9700 }
9701
9702 no_read:
9703
9704 #ifdef PWinGravity
9705 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9706 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9707
9708 if (user_position)
9709 {
9710 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9711 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9712 }
9713 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9714
9715 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9716 }
9717 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9718
9719 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9720
9721 static void
9722 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9723 {
9724 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9725 Arg al[1];
9726
9727 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9728 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9729 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9730 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9731
9732 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9733 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9734
9735 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9736 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9737 }
9738
9739 static void
9740 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9741 {
9742 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9743
9744 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9745 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9746 #endif
9747
9748 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9749 {
9750 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9751 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9752 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9753 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9754 }
9755 else
9756 {
9757 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9758 pixmap. */
9759 return;
9760 }
9761
9762
9763 #ifdef USE_GTK
9764 {
9765 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9766 return;
9767 }
9768
9769 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9770
9771 {
9772 Arg al[1];
9773 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9774 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9775 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9776 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9777 }
9778
9779 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9780
9781 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9782 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9783
9784 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9785 }
9786
9787 void
9788 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9789 {
9790 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9791
9792 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9793 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9794 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9795
9796 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9797 }
9798
9799 \f
9800 /***********************************************************************
9801 Fonts
9802 ***********************************************************************/
9803
9804 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9805
9806 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9807 font table. */
9808
9809 static void
9810 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9811 {
9812 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9813 if (font->driver->check)
9814 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9815 }
9816
9817 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9818
9819 \f
9820 /***********************************************************************
9821 Initialization
9822 ***********************************************************************/
9823
9824 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9825 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9826 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9827 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9828
9829 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9830 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9831 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9832
9833 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9834 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9835 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9836 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9837 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9838 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9839 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9840 };
9841
9842 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9843
9844 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9845
9846 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9847
9848 static int x_initialized;
9849
9850 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9851 the screen number from the server number. */
9852 static int
9853 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9854 {
9855 int seen_colon = 0;
9856 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9857 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9858 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9859
9860 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9861 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9862 length_until_period++;
9863
9864 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9865 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9866 name1 += 4;
9867 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9868 name2 += 4;
9869 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9870 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9871 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9872 name1 += system_name_length;
9873 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9874 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9875 name2 += system_name_length;
9876 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9877 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9878 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9879 name1 += length_until_period;
9880 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9881 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9882 name2 += length_until_period;
9883
9884 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9885 {
9886 if (*name1 == ':')
9887 seen_colon = 1;
9888 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9889 return 1;
9890 }
9891 return (seen_colon
9892 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9893 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9894 }
9895
9896 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9897 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9898 to 5. */
9899 static void
9900 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9901 {
9902 int nr = 0;
9903 int off = 0;
9904
9905 while (!(mask & 1))
9906 {
9907 off++;
9908 mask >>= 1;
9909 }
9910
9911 while (mask & 1)
9912 {
9913 nr++;
9914 mask >>= 1;
9915 }
9916
9917 *offset = off;
9918 *bits = nr;
9919 }
9920
9921 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9922 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9923
9924 int
9925 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9926 {
9927 int dpy_ok = 1;
9928 Display *dpy;
9929
9930 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9931 if (dpy)
9932 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9933 else
9934 dpy_ok = 0;
9935 return dpy_ok;
9936 }
9937
9938 #ifdef USE_GTK
9939 static void
9940 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9941 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9942 {
9943 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9944 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9945 }
9946 #endif
9947
9948 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9949 the structure that describes the open display.
9950 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9951
9952 struct x_display_info *
9953 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9954 {
9955 int connection;
9956 Display *dpy;
9957 struct terminal *terminal;
9958 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9959 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9960 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9961 ptrdiff_t lim;
9962
9963 BLOCK_INPUT;
9964
9965 if (!x_initialized)
9966 {
9967 x_initialize ();
9968 ++x_initialized;
9969 }
9970
9971 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9972 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9973
9974 #ifdef USE_GTK
9975 {
9976 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9977 int argc;
9978 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9979 char **argv2 = argv;
9980 guint id;
9981
9982 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9983 {
9984 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9985 }
9986 else
9987 {
9988 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9989 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9990
9991 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9992 argv[argc] = 0;
9993
9994 argc = 0;
9995 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9996
9997 if (! NILP (display_name))
9998 {
9999 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
10000 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
10001 }
10002
10003 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
10004 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10005
10006 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10007
10008 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10009 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10010 {
10011 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
10012 putenv (fix_events);
10013 }
10014
10015 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10016 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10017 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10018 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10019
10020 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10021 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10022 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10023
10024 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10025 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10026
10027 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10028 fixup_locale ();
10029 xg_initialize ();
10030
10031 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10032
10033 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10034 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10035 {
10036 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10037 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10038
10039 s = build_string (file);
10040 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10041
10042 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10043 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10044 }
10045 #endif
10046
10047 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10048 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10049 }
10050 }
10051 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10052 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10053 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10054 errors with X11R5:
10055 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10056 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10057 So let's not use it until R6. */
10058 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10059 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10060 #endif
10061
10062 {
10063 int argc = 0;
10064 char *argv[3];
10065
10066 argv[0] = "";
10067 argc = 1;
10068 if (xrm_option)
10069 {
10070 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10071 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10072 }
10073 turn_on_atimers (0);
10074 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10075 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10076 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10077 &argc, argv);
10078 turn_on_atimers (1);
10079
10080 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10081 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10082 fixup_locale ();
10083 #endif
10084 }
10085
10086 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10087 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10088 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10089 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10090 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10091
10092 /* Detect failure. */
10093 if (dpy == 0)
10094 {
10095 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10096 return 0;
10097 }
10098
10099 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10100
10101 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10102 memset (dpyinfo, 0, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10103 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10104
10105 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10106
10107 {
10108 struct x_display_info *share;
10109 Lisp_Object tail;
10110
10111 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10112 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10113 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10114 SSDATA (display_name)))
10115 break;
10116 if (share)
10117 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10118 else
10119 {
10120 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10121 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10122 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vwindow_system) = Qx;
10123
10124 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10125 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10126 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10127 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10128 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10129
10130 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10131 {
10132 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10133
10134 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10135 list of terminals. */
10136 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10137 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10138 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10139 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10140
10141 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10142 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10143 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10144 KVAR (terminal->kboard, Vsystem_key_alist)
10145 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10146 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10147 BLOCK_INPUT;
10148 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10149 terminal_list = terminal;
10150 UNGCPRO;
10151 }
10152
10153 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10154 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10155 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10156 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10157 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10158 }
10159 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10160 }
10161
10162 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10163 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10164 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10165
10166 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10167 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10168 x_display_name_list);
10169 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10170
10171 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10172
10173 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10174 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10175 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10176 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10177
10178 #if 0
10179 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10180 #endif /* ! 0 */
10181
10182 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10183 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10184 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10185 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10186 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10187 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10188 + 2);
10189 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10190 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10191
10192 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10193 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10194
10195 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10196 #ifdef USE_GTK
10197 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10198 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10199 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10200
10201 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10202 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10203
10204 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10205 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10206 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10207 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10208 #else
10209 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10210 #endif
10211 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10212 all versions. */
10213 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10214
10215 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10216 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10217 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10218 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10219 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10220 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10221 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10222 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10223 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10224 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10225 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10226 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10227 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10228 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10229 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10230 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10231 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10232 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10233 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10234 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10235 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10236 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10237 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10238 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10239 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10240 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10241 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10242 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10243
10244 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10245 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10246 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10247
10248 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10249 {
10250 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10251 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10252 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10253 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10254 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10255 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10256 }
10257
10258 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10259 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10260 {
10261 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10262 {
10263 Lisp_Object value;
10264 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10265 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10266 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10267 Qnil, Qnil);
10268 if (STRINGP (value)
10269 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10270 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10271 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10272 }
10273 }
10274 else
10275 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10276 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10277
10278 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10279 {
10280 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10281 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10282 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10283 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10284 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10285 for example). */
10286 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10287 double d;
10288 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10289 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10290 }
10291 #endif
10292
10293 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10294 {
10295 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10296 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10297 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10298 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10299 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10300 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10301 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10302 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10303 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10304 }
10305
10306 {
10307 const struct
10308 {
10309 const char *name;
10310 Atom *atom;
10311 } atom_refs[] = {
10312 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10313 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10314 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10315 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10316 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10317 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10318 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10319 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10320 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10321 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10322 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10323 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10324 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10325 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10326 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10327 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10328 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10329 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10330 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10331 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10332 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10333 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10334 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10335 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10336 /* For properties of font. */
10337 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10338 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10339 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10340 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10341 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10342 /* Ghostscript support. */
10343 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10344 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10345 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10346 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10347 /* EWMH */
10348 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10349 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10350 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10351 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10352 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10353 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10354 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10355 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10356 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10357 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10358 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10359 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10360 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10361 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10362 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10363 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10364 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10365 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10366 /* Session management */
10367 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10368 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10369 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10370 };
10371
10372 int i;
10373 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10374 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10375 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10376 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (sizeof (Atom) * total_atom_count);
10377 char **atom_names = xmalloc (sizeof (char *) * total_atom_count);
10378 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10379 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10380 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10381
10382 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10383 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10384
10385 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10386 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10387 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10388 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10389
10390 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10391 False, atoms_return);
10392
10393 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10394 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10395
10396 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10397 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10398
10399 xfree (atom_names);
10400 xfree (atoms_return);
10401 }
10402
10403 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10404 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10405 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10406 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10407
10408 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10409 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10410 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10411
10412 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10413 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10414
10415 {
10416 dpyinfo->gray
10417 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10418 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10419 1, 0, 1);
10420 }
10421
10422 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10423 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10424 #endif
10425
10426 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10427
10428 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10429 if (connection != 0)
10430 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10431
10432 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10433 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10434 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10435
10436 #ifdef SIGIO
10437 if (interrupt_input)
10438 init_sigio (connection);
10439 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10440
10441 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10442 {
10443 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10444 Font font;
10445
10446 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10447 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10448 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10449 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10450 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10451 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10452 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10453 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10454 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10455 abort ();
10456 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10457 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10458 x_uncatch_errors ();
10459 }
10460 #endif
10461
10462 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10463 for debugging X code. */
10464 {
10465 Lisp_Object value;
10466 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10467 build_string ("synchronous"),
10468 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10469 Qnil, Qnil);
10470 if (STRINGP (value)
10471 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10472 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10473 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10474 }
10475
10476 {
10477 Lisp_Object value;
10478 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10479 build_string ("useXIM"),
10480 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10481 Qnil, Qnil);
10482 #ifdef USE_XIM
10483 if (STRINGP (value)
10484 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10485 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10486 use_xim = 0;
10487 #else
10488 if (STRINGP (value)
10489 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10490 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10491 use_xim = 1;
10492 #endif
10493 }
10494
10495 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10496 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10497 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10498 tty. */
10499 if (terminal->id == 1)
10500 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10501 #endif
10502
10503 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10504
10505 return dpyinfo;
10506 }
10507 \f
10508 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10509 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10510
10511 static void
10512 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10513 {
10514 struct terminal *t;
10515
10516 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10517 X display. */
10518 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10519 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10520 {
10521 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10522 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10523 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10524 x_session_close ();
10525 #endif
10526 delete_terminal (t);
10527 break;
10528 }
10529
10530 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10531
10532 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10533 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10534 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10535 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10536 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10537 else
10538 {
10539 Lisp_Object tail;
10540
10541 tail = x_display_name_list;
10542 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10543 {
10544 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10545 {
10546 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10547 break;
10548 }
10549 tail = XCDR (tail);
10550 }
10551 }
10552
10553 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10554 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10555
10556 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10557 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10558 else
10559 {
10560 struct x_display_info *tail;
10561
10562 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10563 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10564 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10565 }
10566
10567 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10568 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10569 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10570 xfree (dpyinfo);
10571 }
10572
10573 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10574
10575 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10576 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10577 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10578 that slows us down. */
10579
10580 static void
10581 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10582 {
10583 BLOCK_INPUT;
10584 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10585 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10586 {
10587 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10588 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10589 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10590 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10591 }
10592 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10593 }
10594
10595 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10596 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10597 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10598 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10599 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10600 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10601 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10602
10603 void
10604 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10605 {
10606 BLOCK_INPUT;
10607 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10608 {
10609 EMACS_TIME interval;
10610
10611 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10612 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10613 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10614 }
10615 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10616 }
10617
10618 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10619
10620 \f
10621 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10622
10623 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10624
10625 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10626 {
10627 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10628 x_produce_glyphs,
10629 x_write_glyphs,
10630 x_insert_glyphs,
10631 x_clear_end_of_line,
10632 x_scroll_run,
10633 x_after_update_window_line,
10634 x_update_window_begin,
10635 x_update_window_end,
10636 x_cursor_to,
10637 x_flush,
10638 #ifdef XFlush
10639 x_flush,
10640 #else
10641 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10642 #endif
10643 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10644 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10645 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10646 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10647 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10648 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10649 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10650 x_draw_glyph_string,
10651 x_define_frame_cursor,
10652 x_clear_frame_area,
10653 x_draw_window_cursor,
10654 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10655 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10656 };
10657
10658
10659 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10660 void
10661 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10662 {
10663 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10664
10665 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10666 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10667 if (!terminal->name)
10668 return;
10669
10670 BLOCK_INPUT;
10671 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10672 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10673 X display. */
10674 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10675 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10676 #endif
10677
10678 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10679 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10680 if (dpyinfo->display)
10681 {
10682 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10683 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10684
10685 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10686 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10687 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10688 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10689
10690 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10691 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10692 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10693 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10694 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10695 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10696 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10697 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10698 leaks in other situations. */
10699 #if 0
10700 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10701 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10702 #else
10703 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10704 #endif
10705 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10706 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10707 closing all the displays. */
10708 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10709 #endif
10710
10711 #ifdef USE_GTK
10712 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10713 #else
10714 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10715 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10716 #else
10717 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10718 #endif
10719 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10720 }
10721
10722 /* Mark as dead. */
10723 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10724 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10725 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10726 }
10727
10728 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10729 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10730
10731 static struct terminal *
10732 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10733 {
10734 struct terminal *terminal;
10735
10736 terminal = create_terminal ();
10737
10738 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10739 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10740 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10741
10742 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10743
10744 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10745 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10746 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10747 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10748 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10749 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10750 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10751 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10752 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10753 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10754 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10755 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10756 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10757 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10758 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10759 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10760 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10761 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10762 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10763 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10764
10765 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10766 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10767
10768 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10769 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10770 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10771 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10772 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10773 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10774 off the bottom. */
10775
10776 return terminal;
10777 }
10778
10779 void
10780 x_initialize (void)
10781 {
10782 baud_rate = 19200;
10783
10784 x_noop_count = 0;
10785 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10786 any_help_event_p = 0;
10787 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10788
10789 #ifdef USE_GTK
10790 current_count = -1;
10791 #endif
10792
10793 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10794 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10795
10796 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10797 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10798
10799 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10800
10801 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10802 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10803 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10804 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10805 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10806 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10807 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10808
10809 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10810 #endif
10811
10812 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10813 #ifndef USE_GTK
10814 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10815 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10816 #endif
10817 #endif
10818
10819 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10820 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10821 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10822
10823 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10824 original error handler. */
10825 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10826 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10827
10828 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10829
10830 xgselect_initialize ();
10831 }
10832
10833
10834 void
10835 syms_of_xterm (void)
10836 {
10837 x_error_message = NULL;
10838
10839 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10840 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10841
10842 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10843 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10844
10845 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10846 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10847
10848 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10849 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10850
10851 #ifdef USE_GTK
10852 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10853 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10854
10855 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10856 #endif
10857
10858 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10859 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10860 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10861 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10862 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10863 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10864 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10865 sizes. */);
10866 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10867
10868 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10869 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10870 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10871 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10872 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10873 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10874 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10875
10876 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10877 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10878 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10879 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10880 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10881 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10882 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10883 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10884 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10885
10886 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10887 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10888 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10889 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10890 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10891 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10892 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10893 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10894 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10895 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10896 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10897 #elif USE_GTK
10898 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10899 #else
10900 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10901 #endif
10902 #else
10903 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10904 #endif
10905
10906 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10907 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10908
10909 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10910 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10911 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10912 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10913 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10914 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10915 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10916 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10917 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10918
10919 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10920 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10921 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10922 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10923 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10924 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10925
10926 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10927 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10928 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10929 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10930 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10931 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10932
10933 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10934 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10935 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10936 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10937 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10938 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10939
10940 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10941 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10942 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10943 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10944 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10945 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10946
10947 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10948 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10949 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10950 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10951 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10952 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10953 }
10954
10955 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */